You are on page 1of 232

Red Hat Enterprise Linux

5
5.3 Release Notes

Release Notes for all architectures.


Edition 3

Ryan Lerch
Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 5.3 Release Notes

Release Notes for all architectures.


Edition 3

Ryan Lerch
Red Hat Engineering Content Services
rlerch@redhat.com
Legal Notice
Copyright © 2008 Red Hat, Inc..

This document is licensed by Red Hat under the Creative Commons Attribution-ShareAlike 3.0
Unported License. If you distribute this document, or a modified version of it, you must provide
attribution to Red Hat, Inc. and provide a link to the original. If the document is modified, all Red Hat
trademarks must be removed.

Red Hat, as the licensor of this document, waives the right to enforce, and agrees not to assert,
Section 4d of CC-BY-SA to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law.

Red Hat, Red Hat Enterprise Linux, the Shadowman logo, JBoss, OpenShift, Fedora, the Infinity
logo, and RHCE are trademarks of Red Hat, Inc., registered in the United States and other
countries.

Linux ® is the registered trademark of Linus Torvalds in the United States and other countries.

Java ® is a registered trademark of Oracle and/or its affiliates.

XFS ® is a trademark of Silicon Graphics International Corp. or its subsidiaries in the United States
and/or other countries.

MySQL ® is a registered trademark of MySQL AB in the United States, the European Union and
other countries.

Node.js ® is an official trademark of Joyent. Red Hat Software Collections is not formally related to
or endorsed by the official Joyent Node.js open source or commercial project.

The OpenStack ® Word Mark and OpenStack logo are either registered trademarks/service marks
or trademarks/service marks of the OpenStack Foundation, in the United States and other countries
and are used with the OpenStack Foundation's permission. We are not affiliated with, endorsed or
sponsored by the OpenStack Foundation, or the OpenStack community.

All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.

Abstract
This document details the Release Notes for Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.
Table of Contents

Table of Contents
. . .Release
1. . . . . . . .Notes
. . . . . Updates
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3. . . . . . . . . .
1.1. Feature Updates 3
1.2. Resolved Issues 6
1.3. Driver Updates 6
1.4. Virtualization 7
1.5. Known Issues 7
1.6. Technology Previews 9

. . .Installation-Related
2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Notes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
...........
2.1. All Architectures 10
2.2. PowerPC Architectures 12
2.3. s390x Architectures 12
2.4. ia64 Architecture 12

. . .Feature
3. . . . . . . .Updates
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
...........

. . .Driver
4. . . . . . Updates
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
...........
4.1. All Architectures 20

. . .Kernel-Related
5. . . . . . . . . . . . . .Notes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
...........
5.1. All Architectures 23
5.2. x86 Architectures 24
5.3. PowerPC Architectures 24
5.4. x86_64 Architectures 25
5.5. s390x Architectures 25
5.6. ia64 Architecture 25

. . .Virtualization
6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
...........
6.1. Feature Updates 26
6.2. Resolved Issues 26
6.3. Known Issues 28

. . .Technology
7. . . . . . . . . . . Previews
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
...........

. . .Resolved
8. . . . . . . . .Issues
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
...........
8.1. All Architectures 34
8.2. x86_64 Architectures 36
8.3. s390x Architectures 37
8.4. PowerPC Architectures 37

. . .Known
9. . . . . . .Issues
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
...........
9.1. All Architectures 37
9.2. x86 Architectures 44
9.3. x86_64 Architectures 44
9.4. PowerPC Architectures 45
9.5. s390x Architectures 45
9.6. ia64 Architecture 46

. . . .Added
10. . . . . . . Packages
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
...........

. . . .Dropped
11. . . . . . . . .Packages
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
...........

. . . .Updated
12. . . . . . . . .Packages
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
...........

. . . .Configuration
13. . . . . . . . . . . . . Changes
. . . . . . . . From
. . . . . Previous
. . . . . . . . .Release
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
............

1
5.3 Release Notes

. . .Revision
A. . . . . . . . .History
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
............

2
1. Release Notes Updates

1. Release Notes Updates

This section contains information about Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 that did not make it into the Release
Notes included in the distribution.

1.1. Feature Updates

audit Update

The audit packages contain user-space utilities for storing and searching the audit records
generated by the audit subsystem in the Linux 2.6 kernel.

These updated packages upgrade the auditd daemon and its utilities to the newer upstream
version 1.7.7, which provides the following enhancements over the previous version:

the auditctl program, which is used to control the behavior of the audit subsystem, now supports
multiple keys in the audit rules.

a new utility, ausyscall, which is used to cross-reference syscall name and number information,
is now provided in these updated packages.

the aureport program has been enhanced to provide reports about keys it sees in audit events.

event log parsing for the ausearch and aureport programs has been improved.

a sample STIG rules file, named "stig.rules", is newly provided in these updated packages. This
file contains the auditctl rules which are loaded whenever the audit daemon is started by init
scripts.

In addition to the listed enhancements, these updated audit packages also include a new feature to
allow a server to aggregate the logs of remote systems. The following instructions can be followed
to enable this feature:

1. The audispd-plugins package should be installed on all clients (but need not be installed on
the server), and the parameters for "remote_server" and "port" should be set in the
/etc/audisp/audisp-remote.conf configuration file.

2. On the server, which aggregates the logs, the "tcp_listen_port" parameter in the
/etc/audit/auditd.conf file must be set to the same port number as the clients.

3. Because the auditd daemon is protected by SELinux, semanage (the SELinux policy
management tool) must also have the same port listed in its database. If the server and
client machines had all been configured to use port 1000, for example, then running this
command would accomplish this:

semanage port -a -t audit_port_t -p tcp 1000

4. The final step in configuring remote log aggregation is to edit the /etc/hosts.allow
configuration file to inform tcp_wrappers which machines or subnets the auditd daemon
should allow connections from.

wpa_supplicant re-base

wpa_supplicant has been re-based to the latest upstream stable version 0.5.10 and include
backported fixes for a number of issues that may affect users of wireless drivers that depend on the
kernel's mac80211 wireless stack. Specific fixes and enhancements include:

3
5.3 Release Notes

Support for a D-Bus control interface has been added. D-Bus is a popular lightweight Inter-
Process Communication mechanism, and the addition of this control interface to
wpa_supplicant allows applications (like NetworkManager) to more reliably control the
supplicant.

Cisco Aironet 340/350 wireless cards were not able to successfully connect to 802.1x-enabled
wireless networks, often used in security sensitive organizations. During the connection
process at the 4-Way WPA handshake stage, sending encryption keys to the driver would clear
the wireless card firmware's authentication state. With this update, the supplicant uses an
alternate method of supplying encryption keys to the kernel driver, allowing authentication state
to be preserved in the Aironet firmware and 802.1x connections to succeed.

Kernel drivers utilizing the new mac80211 wireless stack were sometimes unable to connect to
wireless networks, either failing to find the requested network, or prematurely ending
communication with the wireless access point during the connection process. Some drivers
were prone to reporting multiple disconnection events during the association process, confusing
the supplicant and causing long timeouts. The supplicant also did not sufficiently instruct the
driver to disconnect when switching access points. This update fixes these issues and, in
conjunction with kernel driver updates, allow more wireless hardware to successfully connect to
wireless networks.

NetworkManager re-base

NetworkManager has been updated to version 0.7.0. This update provides the following fixes and
enhancements:

NetworkManager would not display a LEAP password, even when the user selected the "show
password" option. This has been fixed through a rebase to NetworkManager 0.7.

During the beta phase, a version of NetworkManager was unable to automatically start network
interfaces for which "ONBOOT=no" was present in the ifcfg file. NetworkManager now ignores
this value unless "NM_RESPECT_ONBOOT=yes" is also present.

a NetworkManager plug-in was named for its upstream repository. This could cause end-users
to mistake the plug-in for an un-supported addition to Red Hat Enterprise Linux. This plug-in
has been renamed to "ifcfg-rh".

with this update, support has been added to NetworkManager for wired 802.1x authentication.
However, after creating an 802.1x-enabled wired connection in the NetworkManager
connection editor, it may be necessary to log out, then log back in before the connection can be
used from the NetworkManager applet menu.

NetworkManager attempted to set a hostname, but only after X had already done so. The user
could not then open new windows because the authority files had been set by X with a different
hostname. NetworkManager no longer sets hostnames.

an update for NetworkManager that was available in the beta phase would change the run level
enablement of the package during installation, and thus prevent NetworkManager from starting.
NetworkManager no longer changes run level enablements during installation.

on a system with more than one network adapter, network keys saved by the user while
connecting with one adapter would not be available when the user attempted to connect with
the other adapter. NetworkManager can now retrieve and use network keys saved for a
different adapter on the same network.

previously, NetworkManager would not always prompt the user for a new network key if the
protocol or key of a wireless network changed. Although NetworkManager would wait for a new
key, it would not always open a dialog box and allow the user to provide one. NetworkManager
will now open a dialog box when needed.

4
1. Release Notes Updates

several bug fixes and enhancements for NetworkManager were available upstream.
NetworkManager has been rebased to version 0.7 to incorporate these improvements, including
mobile broadband functionality, Phase2 WPA support, and static IP functionality.

NetworkManager would would cause a segmentation fault when resuming a session. This was
caused by the HAL dropping privileges before connecting to D-Bus, meaning that the HAL could
not send signals to NetworkManager. NetworkManager now explicitly permits signals from the
HAL.

sometimes, X would freeze if the NetworkManager menu and a keyring manager window were
open at the same time. This updated package includes a patch from upstream that prevents
this behavior.

if NetworkManager requires a network key from the user, it will open a pop-up window.
However, the applet previously could not steal focus from metacity and would remain in the
background. The window was therefore not obvious to the user. The applet now opens in the
foreground, alerting the user to take action.

when resuming, NetworkManager could sometimes re-establish a wireless connection, but not a
route. A fix for this problem from upstream has been included in this update.

NetworkManager did not previously support Cisco Airo Wi-Fi cards, as these devices did not
respond to NetworkManager's attempts to detect them. NetworkManager can now detect and
use these cards.

the NetworkManager applet would wake up and redraw its icon once per second, even when
NetworkManager was not active. Now, the applet will not wake up unless NetworkManager is
running.

NetworkManager 0.7 connects faster than libnotify can provide a notification bubble. When this
happens, the bubble will appear at the top left corner of the screen, rather than under the
taskbar. NetworkManager notification bubbles are now delayed for a few seconds, allowing
libnotify to react.

dbus-glib re-base

The dbus-glib integration library has been re-based to version 0.73.8 This update provides support
to updated versions of NetworkManager and also implements the following bugfix and
enhancements

cleanup of the DBusGProxy objects treated pending remote method calls incorrectly and may
have resulted in freeing invalid memory. Consequently, processes using DBusGProxy objects
may have crashed when the DBusGProxy object was freed. With this update dbus-glib
correctly handles the destruction of DBusGProxy objects, resolving this issue.

two new function calls, dbus_g_proxy_call_with_timeout and


dbus_g_proxy_begin_call_with_timeout, have been added to dbus-glib providing the
ability to specify a timeout when making a request to a remote service.

dbus-binding-tool now ignores namespaced Extensible Markup Language (XML) nodes when
processing introspection definition files.

sudo Re-base

sudo has been re-based to upstream version 1.6.9. This version of sudo now supports LDAP, and
allows sub-tree searching instead of just base searching (i.e. tree-level only) for sudo rights. This
allows administrators to categorize sudo rights in a tree, making user privileges easier to manage.

5
5.3 Release Notes

Note

the env_reset sudoers option from newer sudo will reset the PATH environment variable.
This is different from the behaviour in sudo-1.9.8. To keep the old behaviour simply add
PATH variable into env_keep in sudoers file.

LVM-based Cluster mirroring

With this update, the ability to create LVM mirrors in a cluster environment (i.e. while using CLVM)
is now available in Red Hat Enterprise Linux It provides for simultaneous access from multiple
cluster machines, like when using a cluster-aware file system. This solution is compatible with
existing single-machine mirrors. When switching a mirrored logical volume between single-machine
and cluster-aware, no resynchronization is necessary.

1.2. Resolved Issues

system-config-network requires the fonts provided with xorg-x11-fonts-Type1 in order to


display. However, this fonts package was not previously set as a dependency for system-config-
network and it was therefore possible (for example, in the case of a minimal installation) for system-
config-network to be present on a system and yet unable to function because these fonts were
missing. This update sets xorg-x11-fonts-Type1 as a dependency for system-config-network
to ensure that these fonts will be available and that system-config-network will display correctly.

In Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2, a 64-bit version of httpd was included in addition to the existing 32-bit
httpd in the PowerPC architecture. If a user installed both versions, an httpd conflict would occur,
preventing httpd from functioning properly.

To resolve this issue, the 64-bit version of httpd has been removed from this release. Any systems with
the previous 64-bit version of httpd installed should remove the package before upgrade.

1.3. Driver Updates

the SCSI device handler infrastructure (scsi_dh) has been updated, providing added support for LSI
RDAC SCSI based storage devices.

the tg3 driver for Broadcom Tigon3 ethernet devices has been updated to version 3.93. This applies
several upstream changes for new hardware. However, the 5785 hardware is not fully supported. This
device may be detected by the driver, but lack of PHY support may cause these chips to not function
correctly and may require the user disable any on-board 5785 cards in the system BIOS.

scsi-target-utils now features iSCSI Extensions for RDMA (iSER), which is based on the Linux
Target (tgt) framework. iSER is included in this release as a Technology Preview, and provides
capabilities for both single and multiple portals on different subnets. Note, however, that there are known
bugs with using multiple portals on the same subnet.

To set up an iSER target component, install the scsi-target-utils and libibverbs-devel


packages. The corresponding library package for your system's Infiniband hardware is also required. For
example, in HCAs that use the cxgb3 driver the libcxgb3 package is needed, and for HCAs using the
mthca driver the libmthca package is need.

The MPT Fusion driver has been updated to version 3.04.06, providing the following bugfixes and
enhancements:

6
1. Release Notes Updates

Previously, the MPT Fusion driver always allocated I/O resources, even if they were not required,
which may have caused issues in low resource environments. With this update, the driver now uses
the pci_enable_device_mem and pci_enable_device functions to differentiate the resource allocations.

Previously, the kernel would panic when the mptsas and mptcl modules were loaded in parallel. With
this update, this issue has been resolved.

Previously, system power state changes (such as hibernation and standby) were not functioning
correctly with 106XE controllers. With this update, the driver has been modified to free and allocate
resources in power management entry points.

1.4. Virtualization

A bug in the IDE/ATA driver stack that could prevent a system using kernel-xen from booting into the
kdump environment is now fixed. In previous releases, this occurred if the system encountered a kernel
panic while an IDE device was performing I/O and the IDE device was being controlled by a device driver
other than libata.

A softlockup may have occurred when creating a guest with a large amount of memory. Consequently, a
call trace of the error was displayed on both the dom0 and the other guest. In this update, this issue has
been resolved.

On systems with large amounts of memory (ie 256GB or more), setting up the dom0 could exhaust the
hypervisor memory heap. To work around this, the xenheap and dom0_size command line arguments had
to be set to valid values for the system. In this update, the hypervisor has been updated to automatically
set these values to a default of 32GB, which resolves this issue.

Due to technical problems with passing TX checksum offload information between paravirtual domains,
the use of TX checksum offload in conjunction with NAT for traffic originating from another domain is not
supported. TX checksum offload can be used together with NAT as long as the NAT rule is applied in the
domain where the traffic originates.

Note that this also applies to fully virtualised domains using paravirtual network drivers. Fully virtualised
domains using fully virtualised drivers are not affected as they do not support TX checksum offload at all.

1.5. Known Issues

Previous versions of the 5.3 Release Notes stated that the CD-ROM/DVD-ROM unit on Dell PowerEdge
R905 servers does not work with Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5. This note was included by error, and does
not apply to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.

kdump now serializes drive creation registration with the rest of the kdump process. Consequently,
kdump may hang waiting for IDE drives to be initialized. In these cases, it is recommended that IDE disks
not be used with kdump.

Improvements have been made to the 'nv' driver, enhancing suspend and resume support on some
systems equipped with nVidia GeForce 8000 and 9000 series devices. Due to technical limitations, this
will not enable suspend/resume on all hardware.

pirut sorts some package lists using the textual representation of a package, which is inconsistent with
the textual representation method used in yum. As such, some package lists (e.g. Optional Packages
list) in pirut may not display names in alphabetical order.

The Hypervisor outputs messages regarding attempts by any guest to write to an MSR. Such messages
contain the statement Domain attempted WRMSR. These messages can be safely ignored;
furthermore, they are rate limited and should pose no performance risk.

When upgrading from Red Hat Enterprise Linux 4 Workstation to 5 Server, OpenOffice will no longer

7
5.3 Release Notes

work correctly with SELinux. This is because the Red Hat Enterprise Linux version of OpenOffice is built
using an incorrect library. As a result, SELinux will prevent OpenOffice from accessing any shared
libraries, causing OpenOffice to fail.

To work around this, update the SELinux context to allow OpenOffice to access shared libraries. To do
so, run the following commands:

semanage fcontext -a -t textrel_shlib_t '/usr/lib/ooo-1.1(/.*)?'

semanage fcontext -a -t textrel_shlib_t '/usr/lib64/ooo-1.1(/.*)?'

restorecon -Rv /usr/lib/ooo-1.19

restorecon -Rv /usr/lib64/ooo-1.19

Alternatively, you can also upgrade your OpenOffice to a correct version compatible with SELinux in Red
Hat Enterprise Linux 5. You can do this by subscribing to the "Productivity App" child channel in Red Hat
Network and running the following command:

yum install openoffice-


{base,calc,draw,emailmerge,graphicfilter,headless,impress,javafilter,math,pyun
o,writer,xsltfilter}

If jumbo frames are enabled on your system, a kernel panic will occur if you attempt to unload the bnx2
module.

Red Hat advises that you avoid removing a block device from a guest while the device is in use. Doing so
causes Xend to lose domain information for the guest.

Accessing the right-click menu of the NetworkManager GNOME applet may cause the GNOME Keyring
Unlock dialog to appear. When this occurs, no XII applications can receive keyboard or mouse input.

To recover from this, switch to a virtual terminal using Ctrl+Alt+F1. Log in as the affected user (or root)
and run killall -9 nm-applet. Then, switch back to X11 using Ctrl+Alt+F7. Your system should
be able to receive keyboard and mouse input, although Red Hat recommends that you logout and login
again to allow the system to fully recover.

On Altix systems with an ATI FireMV graphics adapter, the GUI console may not display on one of the
VGA connectors. To workaround this issue, switch to using the other VGA connector on the dongle.

It has been determined that 1024 byte objects in kernel slab may be lost when a call to pipe() fails. The
problem occurs because pipe() allocates pipe files, and then tries to get free file descriptors for them. If
the process is out of file descriptors, pipe() fails, but it does not clean up properly. A fix for this problem is
planned for a forthcoming 5.3 kernel update.

To workaround this issue, ensure that the process calling do_pipe has adequate file descriptors allocated.

This issue has been observed with multipathd in particular. To avoid the problem with multipathd,
calculate the number of file descriptors (FDs) required using the formula: "FDs = Number of Paths + 32". If
the result is greater than the default value of 1024, then the max_fds value in the defaults section of
multipath.conf should be set to the previously calculated value. For example, if there are 255 LUNs with 8
paths each, the line to be added to the defaults section of multipath.conf would be:

max_fds 2072

The libcmpiutil-devel package depends on tog-pegasus-devel, which for the Red Hat
Enterprise Linux Desktop product is only available from the Workstation option. Therefore, any attempt to
install the libcmpiutil-devel package on a system that does not have a Subscription including the

8
1. Release Notes Updates

Workstation option or is not subscribed to the Workstation channel on the Red Hat Network, will fail with
an unresolved dependency error.

It is possible in rare circumstances, for makedumpfile to produce erroneous results but not have them
reported. This is due to the fact that makedumpfile processes its output data through a pipeline
consisting of several stages. If makedumpfile fails, the other stages will still succeed, effectively
masking the failure. Should a vmcore appear corrupt, and makedumpfile is in use, it is recommended that
the core be recorded without makedumpfile and a bug be reported.

An issue may be encountered when using system-config-cluster to configure a Postgres 8 resource


agent, resulting in the postgresql service failing to start. To include a Postgres resource agent in your
cluster, please check the man page for the agent, and edit the cluster.conf file in an editor, then
update the cluster with the new configuration file using the appropriate cman_tool command.

Due to outstanding driver issues with hardware encryption acceleration, users of Intel WiFi Link 4965,
5100, 5150, 5300, and 5350 wireless cards are advised to disable hardware accelerated encryption using
module parameters. Failure to do so may result in the inability to connect to Wired Equivalent Privacy
(WEP) protected wireless networks after connecting to WiFi Protected Access (WPA) protected wireless
networks.

To do so, add the following options to /etc/modprobe.conf:

alias wlan0 iwlagn


options iwlagn swcrypto50=1 swcrypto=1

(where wlan0 is the default interface name of the first Intel WiFi Link device)

kdump now restarts when CPUs or DIMMs are hot-added to a system. If multiple items are added at the
same time, several sequential restarts may be encountered. This behavior is intentional, as it minimizes
the time-frame where a crash may occur while memory or processors are not being tracked by kdump.

1.6. Technology Previews

Software based Fibre Channel over Ethernet (FCoE)

The Fibre Channel over Ethernet (FCoE) driver (fcoe.ko), along with libfc, provides the ability to
run FCoE over a standard Ethernet card. This capability is provided as a technical preview in Red
Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.

To enable this feature, you must login by writing the network interface name to the
/sys/module/fcoe/parameters/create file, for example:

echo eth6 > /sys/module/fcoe/parameters/create

To logout, write the network interface name to the /sys/module/fcoe/parameters/destroy


file, for example:

echo eth6 > /sys/module/fcoe/parameters/destroy

For further information on software based FCoE refer to: http://www.open-


fcoe.org/openfc/wiki/index.php/FCoE_Initiator_Quickstart.

Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 provides full support for FCoE on three specialized hardware
implementations. These are: Cisco fnic driver, the Emulex lpfc driver, and the Qlogic qla2xx
driver.

9
5.3 Release Notes

iSER Support

iSER support, allowing for block storage transfer across a network, has been added to the scsi-
target-utils package as a Technology Preview. In this release, single portal and multiple
portals on different subnets are supported. There are known bugs when using multiple portals on
the same subnet.

To set up the iSER target component install the scsi-target-utils and libibverbs-devel RPM. The
library package for the InfiniBand hardware that is being used is also required. For example: host
channel adapters that use the cxgb3 driver the libcxgb3 package is needed, and for host
channel adapters using the mthca driver the libmthca package is needed.

There is also a known issue relating to connection timeouts in some situations. Refer to Red Hat
Bugzilla #470627 for more information on this issue.

2. Installation-Related Notes

This section includes information specific to Anaconda and the installation of Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.

Red Hat Network can install the new and changed packages and upgrade an existing Red Hat Enterprise
Linux 5 system. Alternatively, Anaconda can upgrade an existing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 system or
perform a fresh installation of Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.

Note: upgrading from beta releases of Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 to this GA release is not supported.

Further, although Anaconda provides an option for upgrading from earlier major versions of Red Hat
Enterprise Linux to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3, Red Hat does not currently support this. More generally,
Red Hat does not support in-place upgrades between any major versions of Red Hat Enterprise Linux. (A
major version is denoted by a whole number version change. For example, Red Hat Enteprise Linux 4 and
Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 are both major versions of Red Hat Enterprise Linux.)

In-place upgrades across major releases do not preserve all system settings, services or custom
configurations. Consequently, Red Hat strongly recommends fresh installations when upgrading from one
major version to another.

2.1. All Architectures

The Text Mode installation of Anaconda now offers the option of switching to Virtual Network Computing
(VNC) to complete the installation.

Creating or using encrypted software RAID member disks (i.e. software RAID partitions) is not
supported. However, creating encrypted software RAID arrays (e.g. /dev/md0) is supported.

The NFS default for RHEL5 is "locking". Therefore, to mount nfs shares from the %post section of
anaconda, use the mount -o nolock,udp command to start the locking daemon before using nfs to
mount shares.

When installing from CD-ROM or DVD-ROM on a system with an iBFT-configured network device,
Anaconda will not include any iBFT-configured storage devices unless networking is configured. To
enable networking for the installation, use the command linux updates=http://[any] at the
installation boot prompt. Note that [any] can be replaced with any URL.

If your system requires a static IP configuration, use the command linux updates=http://[any]
ip=[IP address] netmask=[netmask] dns=[dns].

When installing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 on a fully virtualized guest, do not use the kernel-xen
kernel. Using this kernel on fully virtualized guests can cause your system to hang.

10
2. Installation-Related Notes

If you are using an Installation Number when installing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 on a fully virtualized
guest, be sure to deselect the Virtualization package group during the installation. The
Virtualization package group option installs the kernel-xen kernel.

Note that paravirtualized guests are not affected by this issue. Paravirtualized guests always use the
kernel-xen kernel.

If you are using the Virtualized kernel when upgrading from Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 to 5.2, you must
reboot after completing the upgrade. You should then boot the system using the updated Virtualized
kernel.

The hypervisors of Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 and 5.2 are not ABI-compatible. If you do not boot the
system after upgrading using the updated Virtualized kernel, the upgraded Virtualization RPMs will not
match the running kernel.

When upgrading to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.1 or later from Red Hat Enterprise Linux 4.6, gcc4 may
cause the upgrade to fail. As such, you should manually remove the gcc4 package before upgrading.

The firstboot language plugin has been removed, as it does not properly and completely reconfigure
the system when a new language is selected.

When provisioning guests during installation, the RHN tools for guests option will not be available. When
this occurs, the system will require an additional entitlement, separate from the entitlement used by dom0.

To prevent the consumption of additional entitlements for guests, install the rhn-virtualization-
common package manually before attempting to register the system to Red Hat Network.

Installing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 on a system with multiple network interfaces and manually
specified IPv6 addresses may result in a partially incorrect networking setup. When this occurs, your IPv6
settings will not be visible on the installed system.

To work around this, set NETWORKING_IPV6 to yes in /etc/sysconfig/network. Then, restart your
network connection using the command service network restart.

If your system has yum-rhn-plugin-0.5.2-5.el5_1.2 (or an earlier version) installed, you will be
unable to upgrade to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 through yum update. To work around this, upgrade
your yum-rhn-plugin to the latest version (using yum update yum-rhn-plugin) before running
yum update.

Previously, anaconda could not access more than 8 SmartArray controllers. In this update, this issue has
been resolved.

A driver disk, supplied by an OEM, is a single image file (*.img), containing potentially multiple driver
packages and kernel modules. These drivers are used during installation to support hardware that
otherwise would not be recognized by Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5. Once the driver packages and kernel
modules are installed on the system, they are placed in the initial RAM disk (initrd) so that they are
loaded when the system boots.

With this release, installation can automatically detect a driver disk (based on its file system label),
thereby using the content of that disk during installation. This behavior is controlled by the installation
command line option dlabel=on, which enables the automatic search. dlabel=on is the default setting
for this release.

All block devices with the file system label OEMDRV are examined and drivers are loaded from these
devices in the order by which they are detected.

11
5.3 Release Notes

Existing encrypted block devices that contain vfat file systems will appear as type foreign in the
partitioning interface; as such, these devices will not be mounted automatically during system boot. To
ensure that such devices are mounted automatically, add an appropriate entry for them to /etc/fstab.
For details on how to do so, refer to man fstab.

2.2. PowerPC Architectures

The minimum RAM required to install Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 is 1GB; the recommended RAM is
2GB. If a machine has less than 1GB RAM, the installation process may hang.

Further, PowerPC-based machines that have only 1GB of RAM experience significant performance issues
under certain RAM-intensive workloads. For a Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 system to perform RAM-
intensive processes optimally, 4GB of RAM is recommended. This ensures the system has the same
number of physical pages as was available on PowerPC machines with 512MB of RAM running Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 4.5 or earlier.

2.3. s390x Architectures

anaconda now supports both ports on CHPID for OSA Express3 cards. The installer will prompt for the
port number in the initial stage of the installation. The value provided for the port also affects installed
network interface startup script. When port 1 is selected, the value portno=1 is added to OPTIONS
parameter of ifcfg-eth* file.

Note

When installing under z/VM, you can add either PORTNO=0 (to use port 0) or PORTNO=1 (to use
port 1) to the CMS configuration file to avoid being prompted for the mode.

Installation on a machine with existing Linux or non-Linux filesystems on DASD block devices may cause
the installer to halt. If this happens, it is necessary to clear out all existing partitions on the DASD devices
you want to use and restart the installer.

2.4. ia64 Architecture

If your system only has 512MB of RAM, attempting to install Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 may fail. To
prevent this, perform a base installation first and install all other packages after the installation finishes.

Using yum to install packages from the 32-bit Compatibility Layer disc may fail. If it does, it is
because the Red Hat package signing key was not imported into the RPM database. This happens if you
have not yet connected to Red Hat Network and obtained updates. To import the key manually, run the
following command as root:

rpm --import /etc/pki/rpm-gpg/RPM-GPG-KEY-redhat-release

Once the Red Hat GPG key is imported, you may now use yum to install packages from the 32-bit
Compatibility Layer disc.

Note that when installing from this disc, it is advisable to use yum instead of rpm to ensure that base OS
dependencies are addressed during installation.

3. Feature Updates

12
3. Feature Updates

Block Device Encryption

Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 includes support for block device encryption using the Linux Unified
Key Setup (LUKS) specification. Encrypting a device protects all data on a block device against
unauthorized access, even if the device has been physically removed from a system. To access
the contents of an encrypted device, a user must provide a passphrase or key as authentication.

For information on setting up disk encryption, refer to Chapter 28 of the Red Hat Enterprise Linux
Installation Guide at: http://redhat.com/docs/

mac80211 802.11a/b/g WiFi protocol stack (mac80211)

The mac80211 stack (formerly known as the devicescape/d80211 stack) is now a supported
feature in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3. It enables the iwlwifi 4965GN wireless driver for Intel®
WiFi Link 4965 hardware which allows certain wireless devices to connect to any WiFi network.

Although the mac80211 component is supported in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3, the symbols are
not included in the symbol whitelist for the kernel.

Global File System 2 (GFS2)

GFS2 is an incremental advancement of GFS. This update applies several significant


improvements that require a change to the on-disk file system format. GFS file systems can be
converted to GFS2 using the utility gfs2_convert, which updates the metadata of a GFS file
system accordingly.

In Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2, GFS2 was provided as a kernel module for evaluation purposes.
In Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3, GFS2 is now part of the kernel package. If the Red Hat Enterprise
Linux 5.2 GFS2 kernel modules have been installed they must be removed to use GFS2 in Red
Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.

Improvements in Driver Disk Support

A driver disk, supplied by an OEM, is a single image file (*.img), containing potentially multiple
driver RPMs and kernel modules. These drivers are used during installation to support hardware
that otherwise would not be recognized. The RPMs are installed on the system and placed into the
initrd so that they are supported when the machine reboots.

With Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3, installation can automatically detect the presence of a driver
disk based on its file system label, and use the content of that disk during installation. This
behavior is controlled by the installation command line option dlabel=on, which enables the
automatic search. All block devices with the file system label OEMDRV are examined and drivers
are loaded from these devices in the order in which they are encountered.

iSCSI Boot Firmware Table

Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 now fully supports the iSCSI Boot Firmware Table (iBFT) which
allows for booting from iSCSI devices. This support required that iSCSI disks (nodes) are no longer
marked to start up automatically; the installed system will no longer automatically connect and login
to iSCSI disks when entering runlevel 3 or 5.

iSCSI is usually used for the root filesystem, in which case this change does does not make a
difference as the initrd will connect and login to the needed iSCSI disks even before the runlevel is
entered.

However if iSCSI disks need to be mounted on non root directories, for example /home or /srv,
then this change will impact you, since the installed system will no longer automatically connect
and login to iSCSI disks that are not used for the root filesystem.

13
5.3 Release Notes

Using iSCSI disks mounted on non root directories is still possible, but requires the use of one of
the following workarounds:

1. Install the system without use of iSCSI disks mounted on non root directories and later
configure the relevant disks and mount points manually

2. Boot the installed system into runlevel 1, and mark any iSCSI disks that are not used for
the root filesystem for automatic startup by using the following command once per disk:

iscsiadm -m node -T target-name -p ip:port -o update -n


node.startup -v automatic

rhythmbox

the rhythmbox audio player has been updated to version 0.11.6. This update provides the option
to use proprietary GStreamer plugins.

lftp Rebase

lftp has now been rebased to version 3.7.1. This applies several upstream feature updates and
bug fixes, including:

A security flaw in the way lftp quoted scripts generated by mirror --script (which could
cause unauthorized privilege escalation) is now fixed.

Using lftp with the option -c no longer causes lftp to hang.

lftp no longer corrupts files during a transfer when using sftp.

For more information on lftp updates applied in this release, refer to http://lftp.yar.ru/news.html.

TTY Input Auditing

TTY input auditing is now supported. If a process is marked for TTY input auditing, the data it
reads from TTYs is audited; this will show up on audit records with type TTY.

You can use the pam_tty_audit module to mark a process (and its child processes) for TTY
input auditing. For instructions on how to do this, refer to man pam_tty_audit(8).

The TTY audit records contain the exact keystrokes read by the audited process. To make data
decoding easier, bash audits the exact command line using the record type USER_TTY.

The "TTY" audit records contain all data read by audited processes from the TTY. This includes
data inserted into the input stream by the TIOCSTI ioctl system call.

SystemTap Re-base

SystemTap has been re-based to version 0.7.2. This update of SystemTap introduces several
minor improvements, along with a few major features. These new features include:

SystemTap now supports symbolic probing on x86, x86-64 and PowerPC architectures. This
enables SystemTap scripts to place probes into user-space applications and shared libraries.
As a result, SystemTap can now provide the same level of debugger probing on some user-
space applications as kernel probing.

For example, if coreutils-debuginfo is installed, you can print a callgraph of the ls


command using
/usr/share/doc/systemtap-version/examples/general/callgraph.stp, as in:

stap para-callgraph.stp 'process("ls").function("*")' -c 'ls -l'

14
3. Feature Updates

In order to reduce the likelihood of an undetected version mismatch between the binary and its
debuginfo RPMs, Red Hat advises that you set the SYSTEMTAP_DEBUGINFO_PATH
environment variable to the value +:.debug:/usr/lib/debug:build.

SystemTap's support for symbolic probes also extends to markers placed into the kernel of this
release. To use these markers, load the kernel-trace kernel module in /etc/rc.local
(using modprobe kernel-trace).

SystemTap also supports remote compilation services. This enables a single computer on the
network to act as a debuginfo/compiler server for local SystemTap clients. The clients auto-
locate the server using mDNS (avahi), and only need the systemtap-client and
systemtap-runtime packages to work.

At present, this feature does not use security mechanisms like encryption. As such, it is
advisable to use remote compilation services only within trusted networks. For more
information, refer to man stap-server.

The kernel update for this release includes a kernel API extension that significantly improves
shutdown of SystemTap scripts. This added kernel API extension eliminates unnecessary
synchronization between individual probe removal operations. As a result, SystemTap scripts
that have hundreds of kernel probes are processed much faster.

This is especially useful for administrators that use scripts with probes containing wildcards that
capture numerous kernel events, such as probe syscall.* {}.

For a complete list of SystemTap updates included in this release, refer to the following URL:

http://sources.redhat.com/git/gitweb.cgi?p=systemtap.git;a=blob_plain;f=NEWS;hb=rhel53

Cluster Manager Update

The Cluster Manager utility (cman) has been updated to version 2.0.97. This applies several bug
fixes and enhancements, most notably:

cman now uses the following firmware versions: APC AOS v3.5.7 and APC rpdu v3.5.6. This
fixes a bug that prevented the APC 7901 from using simple network management protocol
(SNMP) properly.

fence_drac, fence_ilo, fence_egenera, and fence_bladecenter agents now support


ssh.

fence_xvmd key files can now be reloaded without restarting.

A single fence method can now support up to 8 fence devices.

RPM Re-Base

The RedHat Package Manager (RPM) is now re-based to the Fedora 9 upstream version. rpm
now adds secondary architecture-specific macro files on multi-arch systems. In addition, rpm now
meets all certification criteria for inclusion in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.

This update also applies several upstream enhancements and bug fixes to rpm, including:

rpm no longer generates unnecessary .rpmnew and .rpmsave files on multi-arch systems.

A bug in the rpmgiNext() function of rpm prevented proper error reporting. This update
applies the proper semantics for error reporting, thereby ensuring that rpm returns the correct
exit code in all instances.

15
5.3 Release Notes

Open Fabrics Enterprise Distribution (OFED) / opensm

opensm has been updated to the upstream version 3.2, including a minor change to the opensm
library API.

The format of the opensm.conf file has changed. If you have made custom modifications to
your existing opensm.conf, rpm will automatically install the new opensm.conf file as
/etc/ofed/opensm.conf.rpmnew. You will need to migrate your modifications to this file
and then replace the existing opensm.conf file with the result.

Red Hat closely tracks the upstream Open Fabrics Enterprise Distribution (OFED) code base in
order to provide a maximal level of enablement for this still evolving technology. As a
consequence, Red Hat can only preserve API/ABI compatibility across minor releases to the
degree that the upstream project does. This is an exception from the general practice in the
development of Red Hat Enterprise Linux.

Because of this, applications build on top of the OFED stack (listed below), might require
recompilation or even source-level code changes when moving from one minor release of Red
Hat Enterprise Linux to a newer one.

This generally is not required for other applications, built on the Red Hat Enterprise Linux
software stack. The components affected are:

dapl

compat-dapl

ibsim

ibutils

infiniband-diags

libcxgb3

libehca

libibcm

libibcommon

libibmad

libibumad

libibverbs

libipathverbs

libmlx4

libmthca

libnes

librmdacm

libsdp

mpi-selector

16
3. Feature Updates

mpitests

mstflint

mvapich

mvapich2

ofed-docs

openib

openib-mstflint

openib-perftest

openib-tvflash

openmpi

opensm

perftest

qlvnictools

qperf

rds-tools (future)

srptools

tvflash

Net-SNMP Re-Base

Net-SNMP has been re-based to upstream version 5.3.2.2. This update adds Stream Control
Transmission Protocol (SCTP) support (as per RFC 3873, http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc3873.txt) and
introduces two new configuration options (to be used in /etc/snmpd.conf):

dontLogTCPWrappersConnects — suppresses logging of connection attempts.

v1trapaddress — enables administrators to set an agent's IP address inside outgoing SNMP


traps.

This update also features several bug fixes from upstream, including:

The snmpd daemon now functions properly on systems with more than 255 network interfaces.
In addition, snmpd also reports an error now when it is configured to listen on any port higher
than 65535.

A race condition that caused the snmpd daemon to leak file descriptors when reading from
/proc is now fixed.

The snmpd daemon now correctly reports hrProcessorLoad object IDs (OID), even on multi-
CPU hardware. Note, however, that it takes approximately one minute from daemon startup to
calculate the value of the OID.

The net-snmp-devel package is now dependent on the lm_sensors-devel package.

OpenSSL Re-Base for FIPS Certification

17
5.3 Release Notes

The openssl packages upgrade the OpenSSL library to a newer upstream version, which is
currently undergoing the Federal Information Processing Standards validation process (FIPS-140-
2). The FIPS mode is disabled by default, to ensure that the OpenSSL library maintains feature
parity and ABI compatibility with the previous releases of the openssl packages in Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.

This update also applies the following upstream fixes:

By default, zlib compression is used for SSL and TLS connections. On IBM System z
architectures with Central Processor Assist for Cryptographic Function (CPACF), compression
became the main part of the CPU load, and total performance was determined by the speed of
the compression (not the speed of the encryption). When compression is disabled, the total
performance is much higher. In these updated packages, zlib compression for SSL and TLS
connections can be disabled with the OPENSSL_NO_DEFAULT_ZLIB environment variable. For
TLS connections over a slow network, it is better to leave compression on, so that the amount
of data to be transferred is lower.

When using the openssl command with the s_client and s_server options, the default CA
certificates file (/etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt), was not read. This resulted in
certificates failing verification. In order for certificates to pass verification, the -CAfile
/etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt option had to be used. In these updated packages,
the default CA certificates file is read, and no longer needs to be specified with the -CAfile
option.

yum Re-Base

yum has been re-based to upstream version 3.2.18. This update improves the speed at which
yum operates, thereby alleviating the problem posed by the ever-growing number of packages
included with each minor release. In addition, this update also introduces the reinstall command,
improves the interface for several commands, and applies several bug fixes, including:

Any yum commands would fail if the -c option was used to specify a configuration file residing
on a web address (http). This bug is now fixed.

A checkSignal() function in yum called an incorrect exit function; as such, exiting yum
would result in a traceback instead. With this release, yum now exits properly.

flash-plugin Re-Base

The flash-plugin package has been re-based to version 10.0.12.36. This update applies
several security fixes that were included in a previous flash-plugin ASYNC update. Further,
this updated plugin also contains Adobe Flash Player 10, which includes the following bug fixes
and feature enhancements:

Improved stability on the Linux platform by fixing a race condition issue in sound output.

New support for custom filters and effects, native 3D transformation and animation, advanced
audio processing, a new, more flexible text engine, and GPU hardware acceleration.

For more information about this update, refer to the Adobe Flash Player 10 release notes at the
following link:

http://www.adobe.com/support/documentation/en/flashplayer/10/Flash_Player_10_Release_Notes.
pdf

gdb Rebase

gdb has now been rebased to version 6.8. This applies several upstream feature updates and bug
fixes, most notably: support for breakpoints inside C++ templates, constructors and inline

18
3. Feature Updates

fixes, most notably: support for breakpoints inside C++ templates, constructors and inline
functions.

For more information on gdb updates applied in this release, refer to http://sourceware.org/cgi-
bin/cvsweb.cgi/src/gdb/NEWS?rev=1.259.2.1&cvsroot=src.

Instruction Based Sampling on AMD Family10h processors

New hardware profiling support for the AMD Family10h processors has been added for Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.3. These new AMD CPUs support Instruction Based Sampling (IBS). IBS
support requires changes to the oProfile driver to gather this information and initialize the new
Model Specific Registers (MSRs) associated with these new features.

This update adds the new IBS_FETCH and IBS_OP profiling samples to the per CPU buffers and
the event buffers of the oProfile driver. New control entries have also been added to
/dev/oprofile to control IBS sampling. These changes are backward compatible with the
previous PMC only version of the driver, and a separate patch is available to oProfile 0.9.3 to use
this new data.

For more information on IBS refer to the paper: Instruction-Based Sampling: A New Performance
Analysis Technique for AMD Family 10h Processors, November 19, 2007

Squid Re-base

Squid has been re-based to the latest stable upstream version (STABLE21). This update
addresses several bugs, including:

The squid init script always incorrectly returned an exit code of 0. This bug is now fixed,
making squid compliant now with Linux Standard Base.

Using the refresh_stale_hit directive causes error message Clock going backwards
to appear in the squid log file.

The squid installation process did not set up correct ownership of the /usr/local/squid
directory. With this release, the user squid is now the default owner of /usr/local/squid.

Whenever squid attempts to use the function hash_lookup(), it could abort with signal 6.

Using squid_unix_group could cause squid to crash.

Event Multi-Processing Model in Apache

httpd, the Apache HTTP Server package, now includes the experimental event Multi-Processing
Model (MPM). This MPM improves performance by using dedicated threads to handle keepalive
connections.

libgomp re-base

libgomp has been re-based to version 4.3.2-7.el5. The re-base improves OpenMP performance
and adds support for OpenMP version 3.0 when used with the gcc43 compiler.

iSCSI target capability

The iSCSI target capability, delivered as part of the Linux Target (tgt) framework, moves from
Technology Preview to full support in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3. The linux target framework
allows a system to serve block-level SCSI storage to other systems that have a SCSI initiator. This
capability is being initially deployed as a Linux iSCSI target, serving storage over a network to any
iSCSI initiator.

19
5.3 Release Notes

To set up the iSCSI target, install the scsi-target-utils RPM and refer to the instructions in:
/usr/share/doc/scsi-target-utils-[version]/README and /usr/share/doc/scsi-
target-utils-[version]/README.iscsi

4. Driver Updates

4.1. All Architectures

General Driver/Platform Updates

The Intel High Definition Audio driver in ALSA has been updated.

High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) audio support on AMD ATI integrated chipsets has been
updated.

The following Wacom graphics tablets are now supported through the linuxwacom drivers:

Cintiq 20WSX

Intuos3 4x6

the lpfc driver for Emulex Fibre Channel Host Bus Adapters has been updated to version 8.2.0.33.2p.
This applies several upstream changes, most notably:

the NETLINK_SCSITRANSPORT socket is now used

Resolved uninitialized node access.

fixed a bug that caused echotest failure when NPIV is enabled.

fcauthd 1.19 is now required for fibre channel authentication.

dm-multipath now has inbox support for IBM DS4000.

The ixgbe driver now supports the 82598AT dual-port adapter and the 82598 CX4 adapter.

the jsm driver has been updated to add support for Digi Neo PCI Express 4 HiProfile I/O
adapters.

hp-ilo: driver added, providing support for HP Integrated Lights Out (iLO) technology.

The radeon_tp driver is now fully supported in this release. This driver enables the ATI R500/R600
chipsets.

This driver also features the following capabilities:

Modesetting on R500/R600 chipsets

2D acceleration on R500 chipsets

Shadow framebuffer acceleration on R600 chipsets

The powernow-k8 driver is now included in this release as a loadable module. This ensures that existing
driver frameworks (such as the Red Hat Driver Update Model and Dell DKMS) can deliver powernow-k8
driver updates to users as RPM packages without requiring them to upgrade the kernel.

For this release, Red Hat is re-adding pnm2ppa in order to provide support for legacy printers. Note,
however, that this support is deprecated and will be discontinued in future major releases.

20
4. Driver Updates

The ccid driver has been re-based to add support for USB Smartcard keyboards.

the uvcvideo drivers for USB video devices has been added to the kernel in Red Hat Enterprise Linux
5.3.

Network

The bnx2 driver for the Broadcom NetXtreme II network cards has been updated to version 1.7.9. This
update fixes the ethernet ring buffer options on controllers that use bnx2 to fix a bug that caused the
system to panic at boot.

The e1000e driver for Intel PRO/1000 ethernet devices has been updated to the upstream version
0.3.3.3-k2. With this update, the EEPROM and NVM of supported devices are now write-protected.

igb: driver for Intel Gigabit Ethernet Adapters has been updated to version 1.2.45-k2, adding support for
82576 based devices.

the ixgbe driver for Intel(R) 10 Gigabit PCI Express network devices has been updated to version 1.3.18-
k4.

the niu driver has been added to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3, adding support for 10Gbps ethernet
devices on Sun CP3220 systems.

the ipw2100 and ipw2200 drivers for Intel PRO Wireless devices has been backported to Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.3 from Linux Kernel 2.6.25.

the bcm43xx driver for Broadcom Wireless devices has been backported to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3
from Linux Kernel 2.6.25.

the ieee80211 support component for wireless devices has been backported to Red Hat Enterprise
Linux 5.3 from Linux Kernel 2.6.25.

the zd1211rw driver for ZyDas Wireless devices has been updated to match the last non-mac80211
version from just prior to Linux 2.6.25.

the iwlwifi drivers have been updated to version from 2.6.26, adding 802.11n support to iwl4965
wireless devices. Several bug fixes included in post-2.6.26 versions of the driver were also incorporated
into the backported driver.

the myri10ge driver for Myricom Myri-10G Ethernet devices has been updated to version 1.3.2-1.269.

the netxen driver for NetXen network cards has been updated to version 3.4.18.

The bnx2x driver for Broadcom Everest network devices has been updated to version 1.45.23, adding
support for the 57711 hardware.

the forcedeth-msi driver has been updated to fix a bug that prevented proper link-up detection.

the ath5k driver for Atheros wireless devices has been backported to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 from
Linux Kernel 2.6.26.

the rt2x00 drivers for Ralink wireless devices has been backported to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 from
Linux Kernel 2.6.26.

the rtl8180 and rtl8187 drivers for Realtek wireless devices has been backported to Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.3 from Linux Kernel 2.6.26.

Storage

21
5.3 Release Notes

3w-xxxx: driver for 3ware SATA RAID Controllers updated to version 1.26.03. This applies several
upstream changes, most notably:

Fixed a bug that caused data corruption when using a 3ware 7000 or 8000 series card in a system with
greater than 2GB of RAM.

Anaconda no longer hangs on 64-bit architectures when using a 3ware 8006 series card in a system
with greater than 4GB of RAM.

The irq handler is now freed when __tw_shutdown() is initiated. This prevents a possible null
pointer de-reference if an interrupt was shared during shutdown.

RCD bit for caching mode page is now turned on.

ioctl resets and scsi resets are now serialized so they no longer collide.

3w-9xxx: driver for 3ware SATA RAID Controllers updated to version 2.26.08. This applies several
upstream changes, most notably:

The pci_unmap_single() call now functions correctly on systems with greater than 4GB of RAM

Fixed a bug that caused slow write performance.

The DMA mask setting now reverts to 32-bit if 64-bit fails.

Added support for the 3ware 9690SA SAS Controller Device.

megaraid_sas: driver updated to version 4.01-rh1. Several bug fixes are applied by this update,
including:

MFI_POLL_TIMEOUT_SECS is now 60 seconds.

Fixed a bug that caused continuous chip resets and command timeouts due to frame count calculation.

Added support for the LSI Generation 2 Controllers (0078, 0079).

Added a command to shutdown DCMD in the shutdown routine to improve firmware shutdown.

Fixed a bug that caused unexpected interrupts in the hardware Linux driver.

the qla2xxx driver for QLogic Fibre Channel Host Bus Adapters has been updated, adding support for
ISP84XX type cards.

the ibmvscsi drivers for emulating virtual SCSI (vSCSI) devices has been updated, providing support
for virtualized tape devices.

lpfc: driver updated to version 8.2.0.30. This update applies several bug fixes and enhancements,
including:

Improved Enhanced Error Handling (EEH) for PCI adapters on PowerPC architectures

Increased the number of supported NPIV virtual ports

Improved driver logic to control I/O queue depth

Added support for Fibre Channel over Ethernet (FCoE) adapters

Booting from SAN for new hardware is now supported

the cciss driver for HP Smart Array controllers has been updated to version 3.6.20-RH2.

22
5. Kernel-Related Notes

5. Kernel-Related Notes

5.1. All Architectures

relayfs previously had a buffer size limit of 64MB. In this update, the limitation of the memory allocated
to relayfs for on-memory buffers has been increased to 4095MB. This allows SystemTap and other
tracing tools that utilize relayfs the ability to trace more events.

The driver for Dell Remote Access Controller 4 (DRAC4) was not present. Consequently, any
virtual devices provided by the DRAC4 were not being detected by the kernel. In this update, the
pata_sil680 kernel module that provides the appropriate driver has been added, which resolves this issue.

The message buffers for the relay interface were only allocated for online CPUs when relay_open()
was called. Consequently, if an off-line CPU was turned on after relay_open() was called, a kernel
panic would occur. In this update, a new message buffer is allocated dynamically if any new CPUs are
added.

The driver for 8250 based serial ports has been updated to add support for DSR/DTR hardware flow
control.

Support for Dell Wireless Wide Area Network (WWAN) cards has been added to the kernel. Devices that
are now supported are:

Dell Wireless 5700 Mobile Broadband CDMA/EVDO Mini-Card

Dell Wireless 5500 Mobile Broadband HSDPA Mini-Card

Dell Wireless 5505 Mobile Broadband HSDPA Mini-Card

Dell Wireless 5700 Mobile Broadband CDMA/EVDO ExpressCard

Dell Wireless 5510 Mobile Broadband HSDPA ExpressCard

Dell Wireless 5700 Mobile Broadband CDMA/EVDO Mini-Card

Dell Wireless 5700 Mobile Broadband CDMA/EVDO Mini-Card

Dell Wireless 5720

Dell Wireless HSDPA 5520

Dell Wireless HSDPA 5520

Dell Wireless 5520 Voda I Mobile Broadband (3G HSDPA) Mini-Card

the thinkpad_acpi kernel module has been updated to provide enhanced support for newer Thinkpad
models.

The soft lockup detector can now be configured to trigger a kernel panic instead of a warning message.
This makes it possible for users to generate and analyze a crash dump during a soft lockup for forensic
purposes.

To configure the soft lockup detector to generate a panic, set the kernel parameter soft_lockup to 1.
This parameter is set to 0 by default.

oprofile did not correctly identify processors based on the Next-Generation Intel Microarchitecture
(Nehalem). Consequently, the performance monitoring unit could not be used and the processor fell back
to the timer interrupt. The kernel has been updated to resolve this issue.

23
5.3 Release Notes

Support has been added to the kernel for the CPU power state, C3, on the Next-Generation Intel
Microarchitecture (Nehalem). The ability to enter C3 (also known as the sleep state) improves the power
efficiency of the CPU when idle.

Previously, the MAX_ARG_PAGES limit that is set in the kernel was too low, and may have resulted in the
following error:

execve: Argument list too long

In this update, this limit has been increased to 25 percent of the stack size, which resolves this issue.

autofs4 updates have been backported to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 from linux kernel version 2.6.27.

Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 now includes the ability to specify that core files be piped to a forked copy of
a user space application, rather than directly to a file. This is enabled by placing |
path/to/applicationin /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern. When a core is dumped, a copy of
the specified application will be executed, and the core will be piped to it on stdin. This allows for the core
to be augmented, analyzed and actively handled at core dump time.

The file /proc/cpuinfo now reports the ID of the Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC)
that is used by each individual CPU.

The Machine Check Exception (MCE) kernel subsystem has been enhanced to support larger memory
configurations as needed by new systems.

The mount command now supports Kerberos authentication when mounting filesystems via Samba. The
sec=krb5 or sec=krb5i switch allows the kernel to call a userspace application (cifs.upcall) which
returns a SPNEGO (Simple and Protected GSSAPI Negotiation Mechanism) security blob (Binary Large
OBject). The kernel can then use this blob to authenticate with the server and mount the requested
filesystem.

If you configured the kernel parameter kernel.unknown_nmi_panic on a system that used the IOAPIC
NMI watchdog method, a kernel panic could occur. This is because the NMI watchdog could not disable
the source of NMIs securely.

With this release, the NMI watchdog code has been revised to allow users to safely disable the NMI
source. As such, you can now safely configure the kernel parameter kernel.unknown_nmi_panic on
systems that use the IOAPIC NMI watchdog method.

5.2. x86 Architectures

The powernowk8 driver was not performing sufficient checks on the number of running CPUs.
Consequently, when the driver was started, a kernel oops error message may have been reported. In this
update the powernowk8 driver verifies that the number of supported CPUs (supported_cpus) equals
the number of online CPUs (num_online_cpus), which resolves this issue.

5.3. PowerPC Architectures

CPUFreq, the kernel subsystem that scales CPU frequency and voltage, has been updated with improved
support for Cell Processors. This update implements a Synergistic Processing Unit (SPU) aware
CPUFreq governor that enhances the power management of Cell processors.

Error Detection and Correction (EDAC) is now supported on the Cell Broadband Engine Architecture in
Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3. To enable EDAC, use the command: modprobe cell_edac

24
5. Kernel-Related Notes

To check this module has been added to your running kernel, check /var/log/dmesg for output like the
following:

EDAC MC: Ver: 2.0.1 Oct 4 2008


EDAC MC0: Giving out device to cell_edac MIC: DEV cbe-mic
EDAC MC1: Giving out device to cell_edac MIC: DEV cbe-mic

If correctable memory errors are encountered, the following message will be returned to the console:

EDAC MC0: CE page 0xeff, offset 0x5700, grain 0, syndrome 0x51, row 0,
channel
0, label "":

Debugging with hardware watchpoints using a variable that is shared between multiple threads was
causing the GNU Debugger (GDB) to erratically miss trigger events. The kernel has been updated to allow
GDB to consistently receive the watchpoint triggers, improving the reliability of the debugging session.

5.4. x86_64 Architectures

kprobe-booster is now supported on the ia64 and x86_64 architectures, allowing users to probe kernel
events much faster. This feature will also decrease the overhead caused by probing tools (e.g.
SystemTap and Kprobes) on servers running on 64-bit architecture.

Support has been added to the kernel for the _PTC (Processor Throttling Control), _TSS (Throttling
Supported States) and _TPC (Throttling Present Capabilities) objects. This support, which is part of the
Advance Configuration and Power Interface specification (ACPI) provides improved management of
processor throttling.

5.5. s390x Architectures

In zipl.conf, parameters enclosed with double quotes inside of single quotes (ie
parameters='vmhalt="LOGOFF"') were being parsed incorrectly. Consequently, installing the kernel-
kdump package may have failed, resulting in the error:

grubby fatal error: unable to find a suitable template

To resolve this issue, parameters should be enclosed with single quotes inside of double quotes (ie
parameters="vmhalt='LOGOFF'")

Note

The syntax structure of single quotes inside of double quotes is the default in Red hat Enterprise
Linux 5.

5.6. ia64 Architecture

The Dual-Core Intel Itanium 2 processor filled out machine check architecture (MCA) records differently to
previous Intel Itanium processors. The cache check and bus check target identifiers can now be different
in some circumstances. The kernel has been updated to find the correct target identifier.

25
5.3 Release Notes

kprobe-booster is now supported on the ia64 and x86_64 architectures, allowing users to probe kernel
events much faster. This feature will also decrease the overhead caused by probing tools (e.g.
SystemTap and Kprobes) on servers running on 64-bit architecture.

In this update, support for pselect() and ppoll() system calls has been added to the kernel.

6. Virtualization
This section contains information about updates made to Red Hat Enterprise Linux suite of Virtualization
tools.

6.1. Feature Updates

The blktap (blocktap) userspace toolkit has been updated, providing the functionality to monitor the
transfer statistics of blktap backed virtualized guests.

Support was added for the Intel Extended Page Table (EPT) feature, improving performance of fully
virtualized guests on hardware that supports EPT.

e1000 network device emulation for guests has been added in this update, supporting only Windows
2003 guests on the ia64 architecture. To use e1000 emulation, the xm command must be used.

Drivers for virtio, the platform for I/O virtualization in KVM, has been backported to Red Hat Enterprise
Linux 5.3 from Linux Kernel 2.6.27. These drivers will enable KVM guests to achieve higher levels of I/O
performance. Various userspace components such as: anaconda, kudzu, lvm, selinux and
mkinitrd have also been updated to support virtio devices.

The native Linux kernel supports vmcoreinfo automatically, but, to setup kdump on dom0 domains, the
kernel-xen-debuginfo package was needed. With this release, the kernel and the hypervisor have
been modified and now support vmcoreinfo reading and writing kdump natively. Users needing to use
kdump for de-bugging or other investigations on dom0 domains can now do so without installing the
debuginfo or debuginfo-common packages.

Fully virtualized Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 guests encountered suboptimal performance when using
emulated disk and network devices. In this update, the kmod-xenpv package has been included to
simplify the use of paravirtualized disks and networks in fully virtualized guests.

Using these drivers in fully virtualized guests can significantly improve the performance and functionality
of fully virtualized guests. Bug fixes made for netfront and block front drivers are immediately realized and
synchronized with the kernel package.

Guests now have the ability to utilize 2MB backing page memory tables, which can improve system
performance.

6.2. Resolved Issues

6.2.1. All Architectures

Shutting down a paravirtualized guest may have caused the dom0 to stop responding for a period of time.
Delays of several seconds were experienced on guests with large amounts of memory (ie 12GB and
above.) In this update, the virtualized kernel allows the shutdown of a large paravirtualized guest to be
pre-emptible, which resolves this issue.

crash was unable to read the relocation address of the hypervisor from a vmcore file. Consequently,
opening a Virtualized kernel vmcore file with crash would fail, resulting in the error:

26
6. Virtualization

crash: cannot resolve "idle_pg_table_4"

In this update, the hypervisor now saves the address correctly, which resolves this issue.

Previously, paravirtualized guests could only have a maximum of 16 disk devices. In this update, this limit
has been increased to a maximum of 256 disk devices.

Memory reserved for the kdump kernel was incorrect, resulting in unusable crash dumps. In this update,
the memory reservation is now correct, allowing proper crash dumps to be generated.

Attaching a disk with a specific name (ie. /dev/xvdaa, /dev/xvdab, /dev/xvdbc etc.) to a
paravirtualized guest resulted in a corrupted /dev device inside the guest. This update resolves the issue
so that attaching disks with these names to a paravirtualized guest creates the proper /dev device inside
the guest.

Previously, the number of loopback devices was limited to 4. Consequently, this limited the ability to
create bridges on systems with more than 4 network interfaces. In this update, the netloop driver now
creates additional loopback devices as required.

A race condition could occur when creating and destroying virtual network devices. In some
circumstances — especially high load situations — this would cause the virtual device to not respond. In
this update, the state of the virtual device is checked to prevent the race condition from occurring.

a memory leak in virt-manager would be encountered if the application was left running.
Consequently, the application would constantly consume more resources, which may have led to memory
starvation. In this update, the leak has been fixed, which resolves this issue.

the crash utility could not analyze x86_64 vmcores from systems running kernel-xen because the
Red Hat Enterprise Linux hypervisor was relocatable and the relocated physical base address is not
passed in the vmcore file's ELF header. The new --xen_phys_start command line option for the crash
utility allows the user to pass crash the relocated base physical address.

Not all mouse events were being captured and processed by the Paravirtual Frame Buffer
(PVFB). Consequently, the scroll wheel did not function when interacting with a paravirtualized guest
with the Virtual Machine Console. In this update, scroll wheel mouse events are now handled
correctly, which resolves this issue.

Using Virtualization on a machine with a large number of CPUs may have caused the hypervisor to crash
during guest installation. In this update, this issue has been resolved.

On Intel processors that return a CPUID family value of 6, only one performance counter register was
enabled in kernel-xen. Consequently, only counter 0 provided samples. In this update, this issue has
been resolved.

6.2.2. x86 Architectures

On systems with newer CPU's, the CPU APIC ID differs from the CPU ID. Consequently, the virtualized
kernel was unable to initialize CPU frequency scaling. In this update, the virtualized kernel now retrieves
CPU APIC ID from the hypervisor, allowing CPU frequency scaling to be initialized properly.

When running an x86 paravirtualized guest, if a process accessed invalid memory, it would run in a loop
instead of getting a SEGV signal. This was caused a flaw in the way execshield checks were done under
the hypervisor. In this update, this issue has been resolved.

6.2.3. ia64 Architecture

A xend bug that previously caused guest installation failures is now fixed.

27
5.3 Release Notes

the evtchn event channel device lacked locks and memory barriers. This led to xenstore becoming
unresponsive. In this update, this issue has been resolved.

Non-Uniform Memory Access (NUMA) information was not being displayed by the xm info command.
Consequently, node_to_cpu value for each node was being incorrectly returned as no cpus. In this
update, this issue has been resolved.

Previously, creating a guest on a Hardware Virtual Machine (HVM) would fail on processors that include
the VT-i2 technology. In this update, this issue has been resolved.

6.2.4. x86_64 Architectures

When the Dynamic IRQs available for guests virtual machines were exhausted, the dom0 kernel would
crash. In this update, the crash condition has been fixed, and the number of available IRQs has been
increased, which resolves this issue.

On systems with newer CPU's, the CPU APIC ID differs from the CPU ID. Consequently, the virtualized
kernel was unable to initialize CPU frequency scaling. In this update, the virtualized kernel now retrieves
CPU APIC ID from the hypervisor, allowing CPU frequency scaling to be initialized properly.

6.3. Known Issues

6.3.1. All Architectures

Diskette drive media will not be accessible when using the virtualized kernel. To work around this, use a
USB-attached diskette drive instead.

Note that diskette drive media works well with other non-virtualized kernels.

In live migrations of paravirtualized guests, time-dependent guest processes may function improperly if
the corresponding hosts' (dom0) times are not synchronized. Use NTP to synchronize system times for all
corresponding hosts before migration.

Repeated live migration of paravirtualized guests between two hosts may cause one host to panic. If a
host is rebooted after migrating a guest out of the system and before migrating the same guest back, the
panic will not occur.

Formatting a disk when running Windows 2008 or Windows Vista as a guest can crash when the guest
has been booted with multiple virtual CPUs. To work around this, boot the guest with a single virtual CPU
when formatting.

Fully virtualized guests created through virt-manager may sometimes prevent the mouse from moving
freely throughout the screen. To work around this, use virt-manager to configure a USB tablet device
for the guest.

The maximum CPUs must be restricted to less than 128 when on a 128 or greater CPU system. The
maximum that is supported at this time is 126. Use the maxcpus=126 hypervisor argument to limit the
Hypervisor to 126

Fully virtualized guests cannot correct for time lost due to the domain being paused and unpaused. Being
able to correctly track the time across pause and unpause events is one of the advantages of
paravirtualized kernels. This issue is being addressed upstream with replaceable timers, so fully
virtualized guests will have paravirtualized timers. Currently, this code is under development upstream
and should be available in later versions of Red Hat Enterprise Linux.

Repeated migration of paravirtualized guests may result in bad mpa messages on the dom0 console. In
some cases, the hypervisor may also panic.

28
6. Virtualization

To prevent a hypervisor kernel panic, restart the migrated guests once the bad mpa messages appear.

When setting up interface bonding on dom0, the default network-bridge script may cause bonded
network interfaces to alternately switch between unavailable and available. This occurrence is
commonly known as flapping.

To prevent this, replace the standard network-script line in /etc/xen/xend-config.sxp with the
following line:

(network-script network-bridge-bonding netdev=bond0)

Doing so will disable the netloop device, which prevents Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) monitoring
from failing during the address transfer process.

When running multiple guest domains, guest networking may temporarily stop working, resulting in the
following error being reported in the dom0 logs:

Memory squeeze in netback driver

To work around this, raise the amount of memory available to the dom0 with the dom0_mem hypervisor
command line option.

6.3.2. x86 Architectures

Migrating paravirtualized guests through xm migrate [domain] [dom0 IP address] does not
work.

When installing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 on a fully virtualized SMP guest, the installation may freeze.
This can occur when the host (dom0) is running Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2.

To prevent this, set the guest to use a single processor using the install. You can do this by using the --
vcpus=1 option in virt-install. Once the installation is completed, you can set the guest to SMP by
modifying the allocated vcpus in virt-manager.

6.3.3. x86_64 Architectures

Migrating paravirtualized guests through xm migrate [domain] [dom0 IP address] does not
work.

Installing the Virtualization feature may cause a time went backwards warning on HP systems with
model numbers xw9300 and xw9400.

To work around this issue for xw9400 machines, configure the BIOS settings to enable the HPET timer.
Note that this option is not available on xw9300 machines.

Installing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 3.9 on a fully virtualized guest may be extremely slow. In addition,
booting up the guest after installation may result in hda: lost interrupt errors.

To avoid this bootup error, configure the guest to use the SMP kernel.

Upgrading a host (dom0) system to Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 may render existing Red Hat Enterprise
Linux 4.5 SMP paravirtualized guests unbootable. This is more likely to occur when the host system has
more than 4GB of RAM.

29
5.3 Release Notes

To work around this, boot each Red Hat Enterprise Linux 4.5 guest in single CPU mode and upgrade its
kernel to the latest version (for Red Hat Enterprise Linux 4.5.z).

6.3.4. ia64 Architecture

Migrating paravirtualized guests through xm migrate [domain] [dom0 IP address] does not
work.

On some Itanium systems configured for console output to VGA, the dom0 virtualized kernel may fail to
boot. This is because the virtualized kernel failed to properly detect the default console device from the
Extensible Firmware Interface (EFI) settings.

When this occurs, add the boot parameter console=tty to the kernel boot options in
/boot/efi/elilo.conf.

On some Itanium systems (such as the Hitachi Cold Fusion 3e), the serial port cannot be detected in
dom0 when VGA is enabled by the EFI Maintenance Manager. As such, you need to supply the following
serial port information to the dom0 kernel:

Speed in bits/second

Number of data bits

Parity

io_base address

These details must be specified in the append= line of the dom0 kernel in /boot/efi/elilo.conf.
For example:

append="com1=19200,8n1,0x3f8 -- quiet rhgb console=tty0


console=ttyS0,19200n8"

In this example, com1 is the serial port, 19200 is the speed (in bits/second), 8n1 specifies the number of
data bits/parity settings, and 0x3f8 is the io_base address.

Virtualization does not work on some architectures that use Non-Uniform Memory Access (NUMA). As
such, installing the virtualized kernel on systems that use NUMA will result in a boot failure.

Some installation numbers install the virtualized kernel by default. If you have such an installation number
and your system uses NUMA and does not work with kernel-xen, deselect the Virtualization option during
installation.

Currently, live migration of fully virtualized guests is not supported on this architecture. In addition, kexec
and kdump are also not supported for virtualization on this architecture.

7. Technology Previews
Technology Preview features are currently not supported under Red Hat Enterprise Linux subscription
services, may not be functionally complete, and are generally not suitable for production use. However, these
features are included as a customer convenience and to provide the feature with wider exposure.

Customers may find these features useful in a non-production environment. Customers are also free to
provide feedback and functionality suggestions for a Technology Preview feature before it becomes fully
supported. Erratas will be provided for high-severity security issues.

30
7. Technology Previews

During the development of a Technology Preview feature, additional components may become available to
the public for testing. It is the intention of Red Hat to fully support Technology Preview features in a future
release.

ALUA Mode on EMC Clariion

Explicit active-passive failover (ALUA) mode using dm-multipath on EMC Clariion storage is
now available. This mode is provided as per T10 specifications, but is provided in this release only
as a technology preview.

For more information about T10, refer to http://www.t10.org.

ext4

The latest generation of the ext filesystem, ext4, is available in this release as a Technology
Preview. Ext4 is an incremental improvement on the ext3 file system developed by Red Hat and
the Linux community. The release name of the file system for the Technology Preview is ext4dev.

The file system is provided by the ext4dev.ko kernel module, and a new e4fsprogs package,
which contains updated versions of the familiar e2fsprogs administrative tools for use with ext4. To
use, install e4fsprogs and then use commands like mkfs.ext4dev from the e4fsprogs program
to create an ext4-base file system. When referring to the filesystem on a mount commandline or
fstab file, use the filesystem name ext4dev.

FreeIPMI

FreeIPMI is now included in this update as a Technology Preview. FreeIPMI is a collection of


Intelligent Platform Management IPMI system software. It provides in-band and out-of-band
software, along with a development library conforming to the Intelligent Platform Management
Interface (IPMI v1.5 and v2.0) standards.

For more information about FreeIPMI, refer to http://www.gnu.org/software/freeipmi/

TrouSerS and tpm-tools

TrouSerS and tpm-tools are included in this release to enable use of Trusted Platform Module
(TPM) hardware.TPM hardware features include (among others):

Creation, storage, and use of RSA keys securely (without being exposed in memory)

Verification of a platform's software state using cryptographic hashes

TrouSerS is an implementation of the Trusted Computing Group's Software Stack (TSS)


specification. You can use TrouSerS to write applications that make use of TPM hardware. tpm-
tools is a suite of tools used to manage and utilize TPM hardware.

For more information about TrouSerS, refer to http://trousers.sourceforge.net/.

eCryptfs

eCryptfs is a stacked cryptographic file system for Linux. It mounts on individual directories in
existing mounted lower file systems such as EXT3; there is no need to change existing partitions or
file systems in order to start using eCryptfs.

With this release, eCryptfs has been re-based to upstream version 56, which provides several bug
fixes and enhancements. In addition, this update provides a graphical program to help configure
eCryptfs (ecryptfs-mount-helper-gui).

This update also changes the syntax of certain eCryptfs mount options. If you choose to update to
this version of eCryptfs, you should update any affected mount scripts and /etc/fstab entries.

31
5.3 Release Notes

For information about these changes, refer to man ecryptfs.

The following caveats apply to this release of eCryptfs:

Note that the eCryptfs file system will only work properly if the encrypted file system is
mounted once over the underlying directory of the same name. For example:

mount -t ecryptfs /mnt/secret /mnt/secret

The secured portion of the file system should not be exposed, i.e. it should not be mounted to
other mount points, bind mounts, and the like.

eCryptfs mounts on networked file systems (e.g. NFS, Samba) will not work properly.

This version of the eCryptfs kernel driver requires updated userspace, which is provided by
ecryptfs-utils-56-4.el5 or newer.

For more information about eCryptfs, refer to http://ecryptfs.sf.net. You can also refer to
http://ecryptfs.sourceforge.net/README and http://ecryptfs.sourceforge.net/ecryptfs-faq.html for
basic setup information.

Stateless Linux

Stateless Linux is a new way of thinking about how a system should be run and managed,
designed to simplify provisioning and management of large numbers of systems by making them
easily replaceable. This is accomplished primarily by establishing prepared system images which
get replicated and managed across a large number of stateless systems, running the operating
system in a read-only manner (refer to /etc/sysconfig/readonly-root for more details).

In its current state of development, the Stateless features are subsets of the intended goals. As
such, the capability remains as Technology Preview.

Red Hat recommends that those interested in testing stateless code read the HOWTO at
http://fedoraproject.org/wiki/StatelessLinux/HOWTO and join stateless-list@redhat.com.

The enabling infrastructure pieces for Stateless Linux were originally introduced in Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.

AIGLX

AIGLX is a Technology Preview feature of the otherwise fully supported X server. It aims to enable
GL-accelerated effects on a standard desktop. The project consists of the following:

A lightly modified X server.

An updated Mesa package that adds new protocol support.

By installing these components, you can have GL-accelerated effects on your desktop with very
few changes, as well as the ability to enable and disable them at will without replacing your X
server. AIGLX also enables remote GLX applications to take advantage of hardware GLX
acceleration.

FireWire

The firewire-sbp2 module is still included in this update as a Technology Preview. This module
enables connectivity with FireWire storage devices and scanners.

At present, FireWire does not support the following:

IPv4

32
7. Technology Previews

pcilynx host controllers

multi-LUN storage devices

non-exclusive access to storage devices

In addition, the following issues still exist in FireWire:

a memory leak in the SBP2 driver may cause the machine to become unresponsive.

a code in this version does not work properly in big-endian machines. This could lead to
unexpected behavior in PowerPC.

ktune

This release includes ktune (from the ktune package), a service that sets several kernel tuning
parameters to values suitable for specific system profiles. Currently, ktune only provides a profile
for large-memory systems running disk-intensive and network-intensive applications.

The settings provides by ktune do not override those set in /etc/sysctl.conf or through the
kernel command line. ktune may not be suitable on some systems and workloads; as such, you
should test it comprehensively before deploying to production.

You can disable any configuration set by ktune and revert to your normall settings by simply
stopping the ktune service using service ktune stop (as root).

SGPIO Support for dmraid

Serial General Purpose Input Output (SGPIO) is an industry standard communication method used
between a main board and a variety of internal and external hard disk drive bay enclosures. This
method can be used to control LED lights on an enclosure through the AHCI driver interface.

In this release, SGPIO support in dmraid is included as a technology preview. This will allow
dmraid to work properly with disk enclosures.

GCC 4.3

The Gnu Compiler Collection version 4.3 (GCC4.3) is now included in this release as a Technology
Preview. This collection of compilers include C, C++, and Fortran 95 compilers along with support
libraries.

Note that in the gcc43 packages, the default for the gnu89-inline option has been changed to
-fgnu89-inline, whereas upstream and future updates of Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 will
default to -fno-gnu89-inline. This is necessary because many headers shipped as part of
Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 expect GNU in-line semantics instead of ISO C99 semantics. These
headers have not been adjusted to request GNU in-line semantics through attributes.

Kernel Tracepoint Facility

In this update, a new kernel marker/tracepoint facility has been implemented as a Technology
Preview. This interface adds static probe points into the kernel, for use with tools such as
SystemTap.

Device Failure Monitoring of RAID sets

Device Failure Monitoring, using the tools dmraid and dmevent_tool, is included in Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.3 as a Technology Preview. This provides the ability to watch and report device
failures on component devices of RAID sets.

DFS

33
5.3 Release Notes

Starting with Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3, CIFS supports Distributed File System (DFS) as a
Technology Preview.

8. Resolved Issues

8.1. All Architectures

The data for TTY device activity reports was not generating correctly. Consequently, the command sar -
y failed, returning the error:

Requested activities not available in file

In this updated package, sar has been corrected so the -y option outputs the TTY device activity.

Previously, setting max_fds to unlimited in /etc/multipath.conf would prevent the multipathd


daemon from starting. If number of open file descriptors needs to be set to the system maximum,
max_fds should be set to max.

mod_perl is now re-based to version 2.0.4, the latest upstream release. This update applies several
updates, which include a bug fix that now allows mod_perl to work properly with Bugzilla 3.0.

cups is now re-based to version 1.3.7. This update applies several bug fixes and enhancements,
including:

Kerberos authentication is now supported.

User-defined printer and job policies are now loaded correctly.

Remote queue caches are no longer loaded when browsing is disabled.

The classes.conf configuration file now has correct file permissions.

lm_sensors has been re-based to version 2.10.7. This update applies several upstream enhancements
and bug fixes, including a fix that prevents libsensors from crashing with a General parse error
message when k8temp is also loaded.

elfutils has been updated in this release to address the following bugs:

The eu-readelf utility could crash when reading certain input files.

The eu-strip utility is used in the rpmbuild procedures that create new binary packages. It separates
debugging information from executable code, to make -debuginfo packages. A bug in this utility
resulted in unusable debugging information for ET_REL files on the s390 platform; this affects Linux
kernel module files (.ko.debug), and caused the generated kernel-debuginfo packages not to
work with Systemtap on s390.

vnc-server is now re-based to version 4.1.2-14.el5. This update applies the following fixes:

A bug that prevented vncserver from printing error messages when Xvnc failed to start is now fixed.

Xvnc no longer uses the wrong root window depth; it now uses the correct window depth specified by
the -depth option.

A bug that causes the libvnc.so module to crash the X server is now fixed.

Xvnc now supports GLX and RENDER extensions on all architectures.

34
8. Resolved Issues

smartmontools has been re-based to version 5.38. This update improves autodetection of hardware
devices, improves support for CCISS RAID arrays, and features a larger database of supported devices.

This update also fixes a bug wherein SELinux prevented smartmontools from monitoring 3ware RAID
devices. smartmontools can now monitor such devices properly.

python-urlgrabber has been re-based to version 3.1.0-5. This applies several bug fixes from upstream,
including:

yum can now correctly re-download from a yum repository that does not support partial downloads.

yum can now resume an interrupted download even if the yum repository is FTP-based with a
specified port.

The size of progress bars are now dynamic to the terminal width. In addition, progress bars are now
cleaner, and display a percentage of the total downloaded data.

The keepalive signal of python-urlgrabber is now fixed. Previously, a bug in this signal incorrectly
increased memory usage during downloads; in addition, this bug also prevented reposync and
yumdownloader from performing properly when downloading a large number of packages.

yum-utils is now re-based to upstream version 1.1.16. This applies several bug fixes, including:

yum update --security can now properly locate old relevant security updates.

yum-versionlock now works properly against package obsoletes.

This update also includes the yum-fastestmirror plugin, which enables yum to choose the fastest
repository in a mirrorlist.

Samba has been re-based to upstream version 3.2.0. This fixes several bugs, including one that
prevented users from joining domains that used Windows 2003 as their name server. This update also
fixes a bug that caused samba domain membership to break after changing the system password using
net rpc changetrustpw.

For a more comprehensive list of upstream samba updates included this release, refer to
http://www.samba.org/samba/history/samba-3.0.32.html

OpenLDAP has been re-based to upstream version 2.3.43. This applies several upstream bug fixes,
including:

The init script now reports a warning if the slapd daemon cannot read a TLS certificate file.

All libraries in openldap-debuginfo package are now unstripped.

Uninstalling the openldap-devel package no longer breaks OpenLDAP libraries.

Red Hat now distributes additional overlays for OpenLDAP server. Except for syncprov, all overlays can
be found in separate openldap-servers-overlays packages, compiled as dynamically loadable
modules. The syncprov overlay is statically linked to the OpenLDAP server to maintain compatibility
with older OpenLDAP releases.

Because the xterm binary had the set group ID (setgid) bit configured, certain environmental variables
(such as LD_LIBRARY_PATH and TMPDIR) were unset. In this release, the xterm binary now has mode
0755 permissions configured, which resolves this issue.

The recommended method for balancing the load on NIS servers when multiple machines are connecting
with ypbind has changed with this release. The ypbind daemon's behavior has not changed: it still pings
all NIS servers listed in the /etc/ypbind configuration file and then binds to the single fastest-

35
5.3 Release Notes

responding server. Before, it was recommended to list all available NIS servers in each machine's
/etc/ypbind.conf configuration file. However, because even servers under high load can respond
quickly to this ping, thus inadvertently increasing their own load, it is now recommended for administrators
to list a smaller number of available NIS servers in each machine's ypbind.conf, and to vary this list across
machines. In this way, NIS servers are automatically load-balanced due to not every NIS server being
listed as being available to every machine.

OpenMotif has been re-based to upstream version 2.3.1. This update applies several bug fixes, including:

A bug in the way OpenMotif handled the Grab and Ungrab events is now fixed. In previous releases,
this bug could cause the display to lock.

A bug in nedit could cause it to crash when using the nedit graphical user interface. This was caused
by a function in the code that causes a segmentation fault in some cases of item selection, which is
now fixed.

dbus has been re-based to version 1.1.2. This update fixes a bug wherein multi-threaded programs could
cause a deadlock in dbus. In previous releases, as one thread listened to dbus and processed
messages, the second thread would send messages to dbus.

strace has been re-based to version 4.5.18. This fixes several bugs, including:

A bug that caused strace to crash when the -f option was used on some multi-threaded programs
(particularly on 64-bit systems) is now fixed.

A bug that prevented the 64-bit version of strace from executing a vfork() function call on a 32-bit
process is now fixed.

cpuspeed has been updated to version 1.2.1-5. With this update, the cpuspeed init script now loads
the speedstep-centrino module if all other module loads fail. In addition, a user-space bug that
prevented the Powernow-k8 module from loading is now fixed.

The frysk suite of tools have been removed completely from this distribution. frysk was originally
introduced as a technology preview in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.0.

Previously, the partition I/O statistics provided by the iostat -x command were incomplete. In this
update, partition statistics are now calculated in the same manner as disk statistics, providing coherent
and comprehensive I/O statistics at the partition level.

A password disclosure flaw was found with configuration file for the Dovecot mail server. If a system had
the ssl_key_password option defined, any local user could view the SSL key password. (CVE-2008-
4870)

Note

This flaw did not allow the attacker to acquire the contents of the SSL key. The password has no
value without the key file which arbitrary users should not have read access to.

To better protect even this value, however, the dovecot.conf file now supports the "!include_try"
directive. The ssl_key_password option should be moved from dovecot.conf to a new file owned
by, and only readable and writable by, root (ie 0600). This file should be referenced from dovecot.conf
by setting the !include_try /path/to/password/file option.

8.2. x86_64 Architectures

36
9. Known Issues

ksh has been re-based to version 2008-02-02. This update adds multi-byte character handling,
addresses many job control problems and applies several bug fixes from upstream. Note that this update
to ksh preserves compatibility for existing scripts.

8.3. s390x Architectures

A vmconvert bug prevented it from working properly on the vmur device node (/dev/0.0.000c). This
caused vmconvert to fail when attempting to access dumps on the vmur device with the error
vmconvert: Open dump file failed! (Permission denied). An update to s390utils in this
release fixes this issue.

The init script and config file for the mon_procd daemon and mon_fsstatd daemon were missing
from the s390utils package. Consequently these daemons could not be built and used. The missing
files have been added in this update which resolves this issue.

8.4. PowerPC Architectures

A bug that prevented the ehci_hcd module from reloading on this architecture is now fixed. This ensures
that the Belkin 4-port PCI-Express USB Lily adapter (and other similar devices) now function properly
with Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 when they use the ehci_hcd module.

The libhugetlbfs library is now re-based to version 1.3. This update applies several upstream
improvements to the library, thereby improving the performance of applications that use Huge pages.

For a complete list of updates to libhugetlbfs, refer to the following link:

http://sourceforge.net/mailarchive/message.php?msg_name=20080515170754.GA1830%40us.ibm.com

9. Known Issues

9.1. All Architectures

When using the new disk encryption feature to encrypt the root filesystem, the following error message
will be reported on the console when shutting down the system:

Stopping disk encryption [FAILED]

This message can safely be ignored, the shutdown process will complete successfully.

When using an encrypted device, the following error message may be reported during bootup:

insmod: error inserting '/lib/aes_generic.ko': -1 File exists

This message can safely be ignored.

Installation using a Multiple Device (MD) RAID on top of multipath will result in a machine that cannot
boot. Multipath to Storage Area Network (SAN) devices which provide RAID internally are not affected.

When a large number of LUNs are added to a node, multipath can significantly increase the time it takes
for udev to create device nodes for them. If you experience this problem, you can correct it by deleting
the following line in /etc/udev/rules.d/40-multipath.rules:

KERNEL!="dm-[0-9]*", ACTION=="add", PROGRAM=="/bin/bash -c '/sbin/lsmod |


/bin/grep ^dm_multipath'", RUN+="/sbin/multipath -v0 %M:%m"

37
5.3 Release Notes

This line causes udev to run multipath every time a block device is added to the node. Even with this line
removed, multipathd will still automatically create multipath devices, and multipath will still be called
during the boot process, for nodes with multipathed root filesystems. The only change is that multipath
devices will not be automatically created when multipathd is not running, which should not be a problem
for the vast majority of multipath users.

When upgrading from an earlier version of Red Hat Enterprise Linux to 5.3, you may encounter the
following error:

Updating : mypackage ################### [ 472/1655]


rpmdb: unable to lock mutex: Invalid argument

The cause of the locking issue is that the shared futex locking in glibc was enhanced with per-process
futexes between 5.2 and 5.3. As a result, programs running against the 5.2 glibc can not properly perform
shared futex locking against programs running with the 5.3 glibc.

This particular error message is a side effect of a package calling rpm as part of its install scripts. The rpm
instance performing the upgrade is using the prior glibc throughout the upgrade, but the rpm instance
launched from within the script is using the new glibc.

To avoid this error, upgrade glibc first in a separate run:

# yum update glibc


# yum update

You will also see this error if you downgrade glibc to an earlier version on an installed 5.3 system.

mvapich and mvapich2 in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 are compiled to support only InfiniBand/iWARP
interconnects. Consequently, they will not run over ethernet or other network interconnects.

On systems with more than two encrypted block devices, anaconda has a option to provide a global
passphrase. The init scripts, however, do not support this feature. When booting the system, entering
each individual passphrase for all encrypted devices will be required.

When upgrading openmpi using yum, the following warning may be returned:

cannot open `/tmp/openmpi-upgrade-version.*' for reading: No such file or


directory

The message is harmless and can be safely ignored.

Configuring IRQ SMP affinity has no effect on some devices that use message signalled interrupts (MSI)
with no MSI per-vector masking capability. Examples of such devices include Broadcom NetXtreme
Ethernet devices that use the bnx2 driver.

If you need to configure IRQ affinity for such a device, disable MSI by creating a file in
/etc/modprobe.d/ containing the following line:

options bnx2 disable_msi=1

Alternatively, you can disable MSI completely using the kernel boot parameter pci=nomsi.

A bug in the updated /etc/udev/rules.d/50-udev.rules file prevents the creation of persistent


names for tape devices with numbers higher than 9 in their names. For example, a persistent name will
not be created for a tape device with a name of nst12.

38
9. Known Issues

To work around this, add an asterisk (*) after each occurrence of the string nst[0-9] in
/etc/udev/rules.d/50-udev.rules.

The smartctl tool cannot properly read SMART parameters from SATA devices.

A bug in previous versions of openmpi and lam may prevent you from upgrading these packages. This
bug manifests in the following error (when attempting to upgrade openmpi or lam:

error: %preun(openmpi-[version]) scriptlet failed, exit status 2

As such, you need to manually remove older versions of openmpi and lam in order to install their latest
versions. To do so, use the following rpm command:

rpm -qa | grep '^openmpi-\|^lam-' | xargs rpm -e --noscripts --allmatches

When using dm-multipath, if features "1 queue_if_no_path" is specified in


/etc/multipath.conf then any process that issues I/O will hang until one or more paths are restored.

To avoid this, set no_path_retry [N] in /etc/multipath.conf (where [N] is the number of times
the system should retry a path). When you do, remove the features "1 queue_if_no_path" option
from /etc/multipath.conf as well.

If you need to use "1 queue_if_no_path" and experience the issue noted here, use dmsetup to edit
the policy at runtime for a particular LUN (i.e. for which all the paths are unavailable).

To illustrate: run dmsetup message [device] 0 "fail_if_no_path", where [device] is the


multipath device name (e.g. mpath2; do not specify the path) for which you want to change the policy
from "queue_if_no_path" to "fail_if_no_path".

Enabling multiple installed versions of the same kernel module is not supported. In addition to this, a bug
in the way kernel module versions are parsed can sometimes result in enabling an older version of the
same kernel module.

Red Hat recommends that when you install a newer version of an installed kernel module, you should
delete the older one first.

Executing kdump on an IBM Bladecenter QS21 or QS22 configured with NFS root will fail. To avoid this,
specify an NFS dump target in /etc/kdump.conf.

IBM T60 laptops will power off completely when suspended and plugged into a docking station. To avoid
this, boot the system with the argument acpi_sleep=s3_bios.

The QLogic iSCSI Expansion Card for the IBM Bladecenter provides both ethernet and iSCSI functions.
Some parts on the card are shared by both functions. However, the current qla3xxx and qla4xxx
drivers support ethernet and iSCSI functions individually. Both drivers do not support the use of ethernet
and iSCSI functions simultaneously.

Because of this limitation, successive resets (via consecutive ifdown/ifup commands) may hang the
device. To avoid this, allow a 10-second interval after an ifup before issuing an ifdown. Also, allow the
same 10-second interval after an ifdown before issuing an ifup. This interval allows ample time to
stabilize and re-initialize all functions when an ifup is issued.

Laptops equipped with the Cisco Aironet MPI-350 wireless may hang trying to get a DHCP address during
any network-based installation using the wired ethernet port.

39
5.3 Release Notes

To work around this, use local media for your installation. Alternatively, you can disable the wireless card
in the laptop BIOS prior to installation (you can re-enable the wireless card after completing the
installation).

Boot-time logging to /var/log/boot.log is not available in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3.

The system may not successfully reboot into a kexec/kdump kernel if X is running and using a driver
other than vesa. This problem only exists with ATI Rage XL graphics chipsets.

If X is running on a system equipped with ATI Rage XL, ensure that it is using the vesa driver in order to
successfully reboot into a kexec/kdump kernel.

When using Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 on a machine with an nVidia CK804 chipset installed, the
following kernel messages may appear:

kernel: assign_interrupt_mode Found MSI capability


kernel: pcie_portdrv_probe->Dev[005d:10de] has invalid IRQ. Check vendor
BIOS

These messages indicate that certain PCI-E ports are not requesting IRQs. They do not, however, affect
the operation of the machine in any way.

Removable storage devices (such as CDs and DVDs) do not automatically mount when you are logged in
as root. As such, you will need to manually mount the device through the graphical file manager.

Alternatively, you can run the following command to mount a device to /media:

mount /dev/[device name] /media

When a LUN is deleted on a configured storage system, the change is not reflected on the host. In such
cases, lvm commands will hang indefinitely when dm-multipath is used, as the LUN has now become
stale.

To work around this, delete all device and mpath link entries in /etc/lvm/.cache specific to the stale
LUN.

To find out what these entries are, run the following command:

ls -l /dev/mpath | grep [stale LUN]

For example, if [stale LUN] is 3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00, the following results may


appear:

lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 7 Aug 2 10:33 /3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00 -


> ../dm-4
lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 7 Aug 2 10:33 /3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00p1
-> ../dm-5

This means that 3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00 is mapped to two mpath links: dm-4 and dm-5.

As such, the following lines should be deleted from /etc/lvm/.cache:

/dev/dm-4
/dev/dm-5
/dev/mapper/3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00
/dev/mapper/3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00p1

40
9. Known Issues

/dev/mpath/3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00
/dev/mpath/3600d0230003414f30000203a7bc41a00p1

Running the multipath command with the -ll option can cause the command to hang if one of the
paths is on a blocking device. Note that the driver does not fail a request after some time if the device
does not respond.

This is caused by the cleanup code, which waits until the path checker request either completes or fails.
To display the current multipath state without hanging the command, use multipath -l instead.

Upgrading pm-utils from a Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 Beta version of pm-utils will fail, resulting in
the following error:

error: unpacking of archive failed on file /etc/pm/sleep.d: cpio: rename

To prevent this from occurring, delete the /etc/pm/sleep.d/ directory prior to upgrading. If
/etc/pm/sleep.d contains any files, move those files to /etc/pm/hooks/.

Hardware testing for the Mellanox MT25204 has revealed that an internal error occurs under certain high-
load conditions. When the ib_mthca driver reports a catastrophic error on this hardware, it is usually
related to an insufficient completion queue depth relative to the number of outstanding work requests
generated by the user application.

Although the driver will reset the hardware and recover from such an event, all existing connections at the
time of the error will be lost. This generally results in a segmentation fault in the user application. Further,
if opensm is running at the time the error occurs, then you need to manually restart it in order to resume
proper operation.

When installing Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 on a guest, the guest is configured to explicitly use a
temporary installation kernel provided by dom0. Once installation finishes, it can then use its own
bootloader. However, this can only be achieved by forcing the guest's first reboot to be a shutdown.

As such, when the Reboot button appears at the end of the guest installation, clicking it shuts down the
guest, but does not reboot it. This is an expected behavior.

Note that when you boot the guest after this it will then use its own bootloader.

Running rpmbuild on the compiz source RPM will fail if any KDE or qt development packages (for
example, qt-devel) are installed. This is caused by a bug in the compiz configuration script.

To work around this, remove any KDE or qt development packages before attempting to build the
compiz package from its source RPM.

If your system has either ATI Radeon R500 or R600 graphics card equipped, firstboot will not run
after installation. The system will go directly to the graphical login screen and skip firstboot altogether.
If you attempt to run firstboot manually (i.e. from a failsafe terminal), the X session will crash.

This issue is caused by the driver used by the ATI Radeon R500/R600 hardware. The default driver used
by these graphics cards are still in technology preview. To work around this, backup your
/etc/X11/xorg.conf file; then, configure X to use the supported vesa driver instead using the
following command:

system-config-display --reconfig --set-driver=vesa

You can now run firstboot. To switch back to your old settings, restore your original
/etc/X11/xorg.conf.

41
5.3 Release Notes

If your system uses the TSC timer, the gettimeofday system call may move backwards. This is
because of an overflow issue that causes the TSC timer to jump forward significantly in some cases;
when this occurs, the TSC timer will correct itself, but will ultimately register a movement backwards in
time.

This issue is particularly critical for time-sensitive systems, such as those used for transaction systems
and databases. As such, if your system needs precision timing, Red Hat strongly recommends that you
set the kernel to use another timer (for example, HPET).

Attempting to run sniff may result in an error. This is because some required packages are not installed
with dogtail.

To prevent this from occurring, install the following packages manually:

librsvg2

ghostscript-fonts

pygtk2-libglade

Thin Provisioning (also known as "virtual provisioning") will be first released with EMC Symmetrix DMX3
and DMX4. Please refer to the EMC Support Matrix and Symmetrix Enginuity code release notes for
further details.

In /etc/multipath.conf, setting max_fds to unlimited will prevent the multipathd daemon from
starting up properly. As such, you should use a sufficiently high value instead for this setting.

SystemTap currently uses GCC to probe user-space events. GCC is, however, unable to provide
debuggers with precise location list information for parameters. In some cases, GCC also fails to provide
visibility on some parameters. As a consequence, SystemTap scripts that probe user-space may return
inaccurate readings.

The IBM T41 laptop model does not enter Suspend Mode properly; as such, Suspend Mode will still
consume battery life as normal. This is because Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 does not yet include the
radeonfb module.

To work around this, add a script named hal-system-power-suspend to


/usr/share/hal/scripts/ containing the following lines:

chvt 1
radeontool light off
radeontool dac off

This script will ensure that the IBM T41 laptop enters Suspend Mode properly. To ensure that the system
resumes normal operations properly, add the script restore-after-standby to the same directory as
well, containing the following lines:

radeontool dac on
radeontool light on
chvt 7

If the edac module is loaded, BIOS memory reporting will not work. This is because the edac module
clears the register that the BIOS uses for reporting memory errors.

42
9. Known Issues

The current Red Hat Enterprise Linux Driver Update Model instructs the kernel to load all available
modules (including the edac module) by default. If you wish to ensure BIOS memory reporting on your
system, you need to manually blacklist the edac modules. To do so, add the following lines to
/etc/modprobe.conf:

blacklist edac_mc
blacklist i5000_edac
blacklist i3000_edac
blacklist e752x_edac

Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.3 can detect online growing or shrinking of an underlying block device.
However, there is no method to automatically detect that a device has changed size, so manual steps are
required to recognize this and resize any file systems which reside on the given device(s). When a resized
block device is detected, a message like the following will appear in the system logs:

VFS: busy inodes on changed media or resized disk sdi

If the block device was grown, then this message can be safely ignored. However, if the block device was
shrunk without shrinking any data set on the block device first, the data residing on the device may be
corrupted.

It is only possible to do an online resize of a filesystem that was created on the entire LUN (or block
device). If there is a partition table on the block device, then the file system will have to be unmounted to
update the partition table.

If your system has a GFS2 file system mounted, a node may hang if a cached inode is accessed in one
node and unlinked on a different node. When this occurs, the hung node will be unavailable until you
fence and recover it via the normal cluster recovery mechanism. The function calls
gfs2_dinode_dealloc and shrink_dcache_memory will also appear in the stack traces of any
processes stuck in the hung node.

This issue does not affect single-node GFS2 file systems.

The following message may be encountered during system boot:

Could not detect stabilization, waiting 10 seconds.


Reading all physical volumes. This may take a while...

This delay (which may be up to 10 seconds, dependant on the hardware configuration) is necessary to
ensure that the kernel has completed scanning the disks.

The current implementation of User Payload Access in ipmitool allows you to configure devices, but
does not allow you to retrieve the current settings for those devices.

Using the swap --grow parameter in a kickstart file without setting the --maxsize parameter at the
same time makes anaconda impose a restriction on the maximum size of the swap partition. It does not
allow it to grow to fill the device.

For systems with less than 2GB of physical memory, the imposed limit is twice the amount of physical
memory. For systems with more than 2GB, the imposed limit is the size of physical memory plus 2GB.

The gfs2_convert program may not free up all blocks from the GFS metadata that are no longer used
under GFS2. These unused metadata blocks will be discovered and freed the next time gfs2_fsck is run
on the file system. It is recommended that gfs2_fsck be run after the filesystem has been converted to
free the unused blocks. These unused blocks will be flagged by gfs2_fsck with messages such as:

43
5.3 Release Notes

Ondisk and fsck bitmaps differ at block 137 (0x89)


Ondisk status is 1 (Data) but FSCK thinks it should be 0 (Free)
Metadata type is 0 (free)

These messages do not indicate corruption in the GFS2 file system, they indicate blocks that should have
been freed, but were not. The number of blocks needing to be freed will vary depending on the size of the
file system and block size. Many file systems will not encounter this issue at all. Large file systems may
have a small number of blocks (typically less than 100).

9.2. x86 Architectures

When running the bare-metal (non-Virtualized) kernel, the X server may not be able to retrieve EDID
information from the monitor. When this occurs, the graphics driver will be unable to display resolutions
highers than 800x600.

To work around this, add the following line to the ServerLayout section of /etc/X11/xorg.conf:

Option "Int10Backend" "x86emu"

Recording needs to be manually enabled on Dell M4300 and M6300. To do this, perform the following
steps:

Open alsamixer.

Press Tab to toggle [Capture] in the View field (located at the upper left part of the menu).

Press the Space bar.

To verify that recording is enabled, the text above the ADCMux field should display L R CAPTUR.

If encryption is enabled on the boot device during system installation, the following message will be
logged during system boot:

padlock: VIA PadLock not detected.

This message can safely be ignored.

9.3. x86_64 Architectures

Some machines that use NVIDIA graphics cards may display corrupted graphics or fonts when using the
graphical installer or during a graphical login. To work around this, switch to a virtual console and back to
the original X host.

On an IBM T61 laptop, Red Hat recommends that you refrain from clicking the glxgears window (when
glxgears is run). Doing so can lock the system.

To prevent this from occurring, disable the tiling feature. To do so, add the following line in the Device
section of /etc/X11/xorg.conf:

Option "Tiling" "0"

Recording needs to be manually enabled on Dell M4300 and M6300. To do this, perform the following
steps:

Open alsamixer.

44
9. Known Issues

Press Tab to toggle [Capture] in the View field (located at the upper left part of the menu).

Press the Space bar.

To verify that recording is enabled, the text above the ADCMux field should display L R CAPTUR.

If your system uses an Intel 945GM graphics card, do not use the i810 driver. You should use the default
intel driver instead.

On dual-GPU laptops, if one of the graphics chips is Intel-based, the Intel graphics mode cannot drive
any external digital connections (including HDMI, DVI, and DisplayPort). This is a hardware limitation of
the Intel GPU. If you require external digital connections, configure the system to use the discrete
graphics chip (in the BIOS).

9.4. PowerPC Architectures

When using Alt-SysRq-W to debug, the following warning message will appear:

Badness in smp_call_function at arch/powerpc/kernel/smp.c:223

Afterwards, the system will also warn that it will hang. This message should be ignored as it will not cause
the system to hang.

Recording needs to be manually enabled on Dell M4300 and M6300. To do this, perform the following
steps:

Open alsamixer.

Press Tab to toggle [Capture] in the View field (located at the upper left part of the menu).

Press the Space bar.

To verify that recording is enabled, the text above the ADCMux field should display L R CAPTUR.

The size of the PPC kernel image is too large for OpenFirmware to support. Consequently, network
booting will fail, resulting in the following error message:

Please wait, loading kernel...


/pci@8000000f8000000/ide@4,1/disk@0:2,vmlinux-anaconda: No such file or
directory
boot:

To work around this:

Boot to the OpenFirmware prompt, by pressing the '8' key when the IBM splash screen is
displayed.

Run the following command:

setenv real-base 2000000

Boot into System Managment Services (SMS) with the command:

0> dev /packages/gui obe

9.5. s390x Architectures

45
5.3 Release Notes

9.5. s390x Architectures

When running Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 on a z/VM that has more than 2GB of guest storage defined,
invalid data can be read from and written to any FCP and OSA device attached in QDIO mode with the
Queued-I/O assist (QIOASSIST) option enabled. If your system has any such devices attached, Red Hat
recommends that you download and install the corresponding z/VM Program Temporary Fix (PTF) from
the following link:

http://www-1.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=isg1VM64306

It is not possible to directly read and convert a z/VM dump into a file. Instead, you should first copy the
dump from the z/VM reader into a Linux file system using vmur and convert the dump into a Linux-
readable file using vmconvert.

The IBM System z does not provide a traditional Unix-style physical console. As such, Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.2 for the IBM System z does not support the firstboot functionality during initial
program load.

To properly initialize setup for Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 on the IBM System z , run the following
commands after installation:

/usr/bin/setup — provided by the setuptool package.

/usr/bin/rhn_register — provided by the rhn-setup package.

9.6. ia64 Architecture

Some Itanium systems cannot properly produce console output from the kexec purgatory code. This
code contains instructions for backing up the first 640k of memory after a crash.

While purgatory console output can be useful in diagnosing problems, it is not needed for kdump to
properly function. As such, if your Itanium system resets during a kdump operation, disable console
output in purgatory by adding --noio to the KEXEC_ARGS variable in /etc/sysconfig/kdump.

Running perftest will fail if different CPU speeds are detected. As such, you should disable CPU speed
scaling before running perftest.

When the kdump kernel is booted, the following error will appear in the boot log:

mknod: /tmp/initrd.[numbers]/dev/efirtc: No such file or directory

This error results from a malformed request to create the efirtc in an incorrect path. However, the
device path in question is also created statically in the initramfs when the kdump service is started. As
such, the run-time creation of the device node is redundant, harmless, and should not affect the
performance of kdump.

Some systems may be unable to boot the kdump kernel properly. In such cases, use the machvec=dig
kernel parameter.

Recording needs to be manually enabled on Dell M4300 and M6300. To do this, perform the following
steps:

Open alsamixer.

Press Tab to toggle [Capture] in the View field (located at the upper left part of the menu).

Press the Space bar.

46
10. Added Packages

To verify that recording is enabled, the text above the ADCMux field should display L R CAPTUR.

On Intel Itanium-based systems running SELinux in enforcing mode, either the


allow_unconfined_execmem_dyntrans or allow_execmem Booleans must be turned on to allow
the IA-32 Execution Layer (the ia32el service) to operate correctly. If the
allow_unconfined_execmem_dyntrans Boolean is off, but the allow_execmem Boolean is on,
which it is by default in Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5, the ia32el service supports 32-bit emulation; however,
if both Booleans are off, emulation fails.

10. Added Packages

cmirror-1.1.36-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: cmirror - The Cluster Mirror Package

Description:

cmirror - Cluster Mirroring

cmirror-kmod-0.1.21-10.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: cmirror kernel modules

Description:

cmirror-kmod - The Cluster Mirror kernel modules

compat-libcom_err-1.0-7

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A libcom_err compatibility library

Description:

The compat-libcom_err package contains libcom_err.so.3, which may


be required
by applications which were built against older packages of MIT
Kerberos.

crash-spu-commands-1.1-1

Group: Development/Debuggers

Summary: Cell/B.E. SPU commands extension for crash

Description:

Specific commands for debugging SPU run control data using crash.

dapl-2.0.13-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

47
5.3 Release Notes

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Library providing access to the DAT 1.2 and 2.0 APIs

Description:

libdat and libdapl provide a userspace implementation of the DAT


1.2 and 2.0
API that is built to natively support InfiniBand/iWARP network
technology.

dstat-0.6.6-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Versatile resource statistics tool

Description:

Dstat is a versatile replacement for vmstat, iostat, netstat and


ifstat.
Dstat overcomes some of their limitations and adds some extra
features,
more counters and flexibility. Dstat is handy for monitoring
systems
during performance tuning tests, benchmarks or troubleshooting.

Dstat allows you to view all of your system resources instantly,


you
can eg. compare disk usage in combination with interrupts from
your
IDE controller, or compare the network bandwidth numbers directly
with the disk throughput (in the same interval).

Dstat gives you detailed selective information in columns and


clearly
indicates in what magnitude and unit the output is displayed. Less
confusion, less mistakes.

e4fsprogs-1.41.1-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Utilities for managing the fourth extended (ext4) filesystem

Description:

The e4fsprogs package contains a number of utilities for creating,


checking, modifying, and correcting any inconsistencies in the
fourth extended (ext4) filesystem. E4fsprogs contains
e4fsck (used to repair filesystem inconsistencies after an unclean
shutdown), mke4fs (used to initialize a partition to contain an
empty ext4 filesystem), debugfs (used to examine the internal
structure of a filesystem, to manually repair a corrupted
filesystem, or to create test cases for e4fsck), tune4fs (used to
modify filesystem parameters), and most of the other core ext4fs
filesystem utilities.

48
10. Added Packages

Please note that "e4fsprogs" simply contains renamed static


binaries
from the equivalent upstream e2fsprogs release; it is packaged
this
way for Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 to ensure that the many changes
included for ext4 do not destabilize the core e2fsprogs in RHEL5.

You should install the e4fsprogs package if you need to manage the
performance of an ext4 filesystem.

ecryptfs-utils-56-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The eCryptfs mount helper and support libraries

Description:

eCryptfs is a stacked cryptographic filesystem that ships in the


Linux kernel. This package provides the mount helper and
supporting
libraries to perform key management and mount functions.

Install ecryptfs-utils if you would like to mount eCryptfs.

fipscheck-1.0.3-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A library for integrity verification of FIPS validated


modules

Description:

FIPSCheck is a library for integrity verification of FIPS


validated
modules. The package also provides helper binaries for creation and
verification of the HMAC-SHA256 checksum files.

freeipmi-0.5.1-6.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: FreeIPMI

Description:

The FreeIPMI project provides "Remote-Console" (out-of-band) and


"System Management Software" (in-band) based on Intelligent
Platform Management Interface specification.

This package contains a Technology Preview for FreeIPMI. Please


visit
http://www.redhat.com/support/service/ for details on the Red Hat
support
policies.

49
5.3 Release Notes

gcc43-4.3.2-7.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: Preview of GCC version 4.3

Description:

The gcc43 package contains preview the GNU Compiler Collection


version 4.3.

gtk-vnc-0.3.2-3.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A GTK widget for VNC clients

Description:

gtk-vnc is a VNC viewer widget for GTK. It is built using


coroutines
allowing it to be completely asynchronous while remaining single
threaded.

ibsim-0.4-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: InfiniBand fabric simulator for management

Description:

ibsim provides simulation of infiniband fabric for using with OFA


OpenSM,
diagnostic and management tools.

infiniband-diags-1.4.1-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: OpenFabrics Alliance InfiniBand Diagnostic Tools

Description:

This package provides IB diagnostic programs and scripts needed to


diagnose an IB subnet.

isns-utils-0.91-0.1.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The iSNS daemon and utility programs

Description:

The iSNS package contains the daemon and tools to setup a iSNS

50
10. Added Packages

server,
and iSNS client tools. The Internet Storage Name Service (iSNS)
protocol
allows automated discovery, management and configuration of iSCSI
and
Fibre Channel devices (using iFCP gateways) on a TCP/IP network.

java-1.6.0-openjdk-1.6.0.0-0.25.b09.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: OpenJDK Runtime Environment

Description:

The OpenJDK runtime environment.

ktune-0.2-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Server performance tuning service

Description:

ktune provides settings for server performance tuning. Please have


a look at
/etc/sysconfig/ktune and /etc/sysctl.ktune for tuning
parameters.

libcmpiutil-0.4-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: CMPI Utility Library

Description:

Libcmpiutil is a library of utility functions for CMPI providers.


The goal is to reduce the amount of repetitive work done in
most CMPI providers by encapsulating common procedures with more
"normal" APIs. This extends from operations like getting typed
instance properties to standardizing method dispatch and argument
checking.

libcxgb3-1.2.2-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Chelsio T3 iWARP HCA Userspace Driver

Description:

Userspace hardware driver for use with the libibverbs


InfiniBand/iWARP verbs
library. This driver enables Chelsio iWARP capable ethernet
devices.

51
5.3 Release Notes

libehca-1.2-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: IBM InfiniBand HCA Userspace Driver

Description:

IBM hardware driver for use with libibverbs user space verbs
access
library.

libibcm-1.0.3-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Userspace InfiniBand Communication Manager.

Description:

libibcm provides a userspace InfiniBand Communication Managment


library.

libibcommon-1.1.1-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: OpenFabrics Alliance InfiniBand management common library

Description:

libibcommon provides common utility functions for the OFA


diagnostic and
management tools.

libibmad-1.2.1-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: OpenFabrics Alliance InfiniBand MAD library

Description:

libibmad provides low layer IB functions for use by the IB


diagnostic
and management programs. These include MAD, SA, SMP, and other
basic
IB functions.

libibumad-1.2.1-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: OpenFabrics Alliance InfiniBand umad (user MAD) library

Description:

52
10. Added Packages

libibumad provides the user MAD library functions which sit on top
of
the user MAD modules in the kernel. These are used by the IB
diagnostic
and management tools, including OpenSM.

libibverbs-1.1.2-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Library providing access to InfiniBand/iWARP hardware verbs


protocol

Description:

libibverbs is a library that allows userspace processes to use


InfiniBand/iWARP "verbs" as described in the InfiniBand
Architecture
Specification. This includes direct hardware access for fast path
operations.

For this library to be useful, a device-specific plug-in module


should
also be installed.

libipathverbs-1.1-11.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: QLogic InfiniPath HCA Userspace Driver

Description:

QLogic hardware driver for use with libibverbs user space verbs
access
library. This driver supports QLogic InfiniPath based cards.

libmlx4-1.0-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Mellanox ConnectX InfiniBand HCA Userspace Driver

Description:

Mellanox hardware driver for use with libibverbs user space verbs
access
library. This driver supports Mellanox ConnectX architecture
cards.

libmthca-1.0.5-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Mellanox InfiniBand HCA Userspace Driver

53
5.3 Release Notes

Description:

Mellanox hardware driver for use with libibverbs user space verbs
access
library. This driver supports Mellanox based Single Data Rate and
Dual Data
Rate cards, including those from Cisco, Topspin, and Voltaire. It
does
not support the Connect-X architecture based Quad Data Rate cards
(libmlx4
handles that hardware).

libnes-0.5-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: NetEffect RNIC Userspace Driver

Description:

Userspace hardware driver for use with the libibverbs


InfiniBand/iWARP verbs
library. This driver enables NetEffect iWARP capable ethernet
devices.

librdmacm-1.0.8-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Userspace RDMA Connection Manager.

Description:

librdmacm provides a userspace RDMA Communication Managment API.

libsdp-1.1.99-10.el5_2

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A library for direct userspace use of Sockets Direct Protocol

Description:

libsdp is an LD_PRELOAD-able library that can be used to have


existing
applications use InfiniBand Sockets Direct Protocol (SDP) instead
of
TCP sockets, transparently and without recompilation. For
information
on how to configure libsdp, see libsdp.conf, which is installed in
$(sysconfdir) (usually /usr/local/etc or /etc).

libsmi-0.4.5-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

54
10. Added Packages

Summary: A library to access SMI MIB information

Description:

Libsmi is a C library to access MIB module information through


a well defined API that hides the nasty details of locating
and parsing SMIv1/v2 MIB modules.

This package contains tools to check, dump, and convert MIB


definitions and a steadily maintained and revised archive
of all IETF and IANA maintained standard MIB modules.

libspe2-2.2.80.121-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: SPE Runtime Management Library

Description:

SPE Runtime Management Library for the


Cell Broadband Engine Architecture.

libvirt-cim-0.5.1-4.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A CIM provider for libvirt

Description:

Libvirt-cim is a CMPI CIM provider that implements the DMTF SVPC


virtualization model. The goal is to support most of the features
exported by libvirt itself, enabling management of multiple
platforms with a single provider.

mpi-selector-1.0.1-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Provides site-wide and per-user MPI implementation selection

Description:

A simple tool that allows system administrators to set a site-wide


default for which MPI implementation is to be used, but also allow
users to set their own default MPI implementation, thereby
overriding
the site-wide default.

The default can be changed easily via the mpi-selector command --


editing of shell startup files is not required.

mpitests-3.0-2.el5

Group: Applications

55
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: MPI Benchmarks and tests

Description:

Set of popular MPI benchmarks:


IMB-2.3
Presta-1.4.0
OSU benchmarks ver 2.2

mstflint-1.3-1.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Mellanox firmware burning tool

Description:

This package contains a burning tool for Mellanox manufactured HCA


cards.
It also provides access to the relevant source code.

mvapich-1.1.0-0.2931.3.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: MPI implementation over Infiniband RDMA-enabled interconnect

Description:

This is high performance and scalable MPI-1 implementation over


Infiniband and RDMA-enabled interconnect.
This implementation is based on MPICH and MVICH. MVAPICH is
pronounced as `em-vah-pich''.

mvapich2-1.0.3-3.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: OSU MVAPICH2 MPI package

Description:

This is an MPI-2 implementation which includes all MPI-1 features.


It is
based on MPICH2 and MVICH.

nedit-5.5-21.el5

Group: Applications/Editors

Summary: A GUI text editor for systems with X

Description:

NEdit is a GUI text editor for the X Window System. NEdit is


very easy to use, especially if you are familiar with the
Macintosh(TM) or Microsoft(TM) Windows(TM) style of interface.

56
10. Added Packages

nspluginwrapper-0.9.91.5-22.el5

Group: Networking/WWW

Summary: A compatibility layer for Netscape 4 plugins

Description:

nspluginwrapper makes it possible to use Netscape 4 compatible


plugins
compiled for ppc into Mozilla for another architecture, e.g.
x86_64.

This package consists in:


* npviewer: the plugin viewer
* npwrapper.so: the browser-side plugin
* mozilla-plugin-config: a tool to manage plugins installation and
update

ofed-docs-1.3.2-0.20080728.0355.1.el5

Group: Documentation/Man

Summary: OpenFabrics Enterprise Distribution documentation

Description:

Documentation from OFED 1.3

opensm-3.2.2-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: OpenIB InfiniBand Subnet Manager and management utilities

Description:

OpenSM is the OpenIB project's Subnet Manager for Infiniband


networks.
The subnet manager is run as a system daemon on one of the
machines in
the infiniband fabric to manage the fabric's routing state. This
package
also contains various tools for diagnosing and testing Infiniband
networks
that can be used from any machine and do not need to be run on a
machine
running the opensm daemon.

openswan-2.6.14-1.el5_2.1

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Openswan IPSEC implementation

Description:

57
5.3 Release Notes

Openswan is a free implementation of IPSEC & IKE for Linux. IPSEC


is
the Internet Protocol Security and uses strong cryptography to
provide
both authentication and encryption services. These services allow
you
to build secure tunnels through untrusted networks. Everything
passing
through the untrusted net is encrypted by the ipsec gateway
machine and
decrypted by the gateway at the other end of the tunnel. The
resulting
tunnel is a virtual private network or VPN.

This package contains the daemons and userland tools for setting
up
Openswan on a freeswan enabled kernel.

perftest-1.2-11.el5

Group: Productivity/Networking/Diagnostic

Summary: IB Performance tests

Description:

gen2 uverbs microbenchmarks

perl-Archive-Zip-1.16-1.2.1

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Perl library for accessing Zip archives

Description:

The Archive::Zip module allows a Perl program to create,


manipulate,
read, and write Zip archive files.
Zip archives can be created, or you can read from existing zip
files.
Once created, they can be written to files, streams, or strings.
Members can be added, removed, extracted, replaced, rearranged,
and
enumerated. They can also be renamed or have their dates,
comments,
or other attributes queried or modified. Their data can be
compressed
or uncompressed as needed. Members can be created from members in
existing Zip files, or from existing directories, files, or
strings.

perl-Config-General-2.40-1.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

58
10. Added Packages

Summary: Generic configuration module for Perl

Description:

This module opens a config file and parses it's contents for
you. After parsing the module returns a hash structure which
contains
the representation of the config file.
The format of config files supported by Config::General is
inspired by
the well known apache config format, in fact, this module is 100%
read-compatible to apache configs, but you can also just use simple
name/value pairs in your config files.
In addition to the capabilities of a apache config file it
supports
some enhancements such as here-documents, C- style comments or
multiline options. It is also possible to save the config back to
disk, which makes the module a perfect backend for configuration
interfaces.
It is possible to use variables in config files and there exists
also
support for object oriented access to the configuration.

pexpect-2.3-1.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: Pure Python Expect-like module

Description:

Pexpect is a pure Python module for spawning child applications;


controlling
them; and responding to expected patterns in their output. Pexpect
works like
Don Libes' Expect. Pexpect allows your script to spawn a child
application and
control it as if a human were typing commands.

Pexpect can be used for automating interactive applications such


as ssh, ftp,
passwd, telnet, etc. It can be used to automate setup scripts for
duplicating
software package installations on different servers. And it can be
used for
automated software testing. Pexpect is in the spirit of Don Libes'
Expect, but
Pexpect is pure Python. Unlike other Expect-like modules for
Python, Pexpect
does not require TCL or Expect nor does it require C extensions to
be compiled.
It should work on any platform that supports the standard Python
pty module.

python-iniparse-0.2.3-4.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

59
5.3 Release Notes

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Python Module for Accessing and Modifying Configuration Data


in INI files

Description:

iniparse is an INI parser for Python which is API compatible


with the standard library's ConfigParser, preserves structure of
INI
files (order of sections & options, indentation, comments, and
blank
lines are preserved when data is updated), and is more convenient
to
use.

python-setuptools-0.6c5-2.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: Download, build, install, upgrade, and uninstall Python


packages

Description:

setuptools is a collection of enhancements to the Python distutils


that allow
you to more easily build and distribute Python packages,
especially ones that
have dependencies on other packages.

qlvnictools-0.0.1-10.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: VNIC ULP service

Description:

VNIC ULP service

qperf-0.4.1-2.el5

Group: Networking/Diagnostic

Summary: Measure socket and RDMA performance

Description:

Measure socket and RDMA performance.

rsyslog-2.0.6-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Enhanced system logging and kernel message trapping daemons

60
10. Added Packages

Description:

Rsyslog is an enhanced multi-threaded syslogd supporting, among


others, MySQL,
syslog/tcp, RFC 3195, permitted sender lists, filtering on any
message part,
and fine grain output format control. It is quite compatible to
stock sysklogd
and can be used as a drop-in replacement. Its advanced features
make it
suitable for enterprise-class, encryption protected syslog relay
chains while
at the same time being very easy to setup for the novice user.

setroubleshoot-plugins-2.0.4-2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Analysis plugins for use with setroubleshoot

Description:

This package provides a set of analysis plugins for use with


setroubleshoot. Each plugin has the capacity to analyze SELinux
AVC
data and system data to provide user friendly reports describing
how
to interpret SELinux AVC denials.

sgpio-1.2.0_10-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: SGPIO captive backplane tool

Description:

Intel SGPIO enclosure management utility


This package contains (part of) a Technology Preview for
Application for AHCI driver with SGPIO support.
Please visit http://www.redhat.com/support/service/ for details on
the
Red Hat support policies.

srptools-0.0.4-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tools for using the InfiniBand SRP protocol devices

Description:

In conjunction with the kernel ib_srp driver, srptools allows you


to
discover and use SCSI devices via the SCSI RDMA Protocol over
InfiniBand.

61
5.3 Release Notes

system-config-netboot-0.1.45.1-1.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: network booting/install configuration utility (GUI)

Description:

system-config-netboot is a utility which allows you to configure


diskless environments and network installations.

tpm-tools-1.3.1-1.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Management tools for the TPM hardware

Description:

tpm-tools is a group of tools to manage and utilize the Trusted


Computing
Group's TPM hardware. TPM hardware can create, store and use RSA
keys
securely (without ever being exposed in memory), verify a
platform's
software state using cryptographic hashes and more.

trousers-0.3.1-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: TCG's Software Stack v1.2

Description:

TrouSerS is an implementation of the Trusted Computing Group's


Software Stack
(TSS) specification. You can use TrouSerS to write applications
that make use
of your TPM hardware. TPM hardware can create, store and use RSA
keys
securely (without ever being exposed in memory), verify a
platform's software
state using cryptographic hashes and more.

tvflash-0.9.0-2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Tool to manage Mellanox HCA firmware flash memory

Description:

tvflash is used to query and update the firmware flash memory


attached
to Mellanox InfiniBand HCAs.

62
10. Added Packages

udftools-1.0.0b3-0.1.el5

Group: Applications/Archiving

Summary: Linux UDF Filesystem userspace utilities

Description:

Linux UDF Filesystem userspace utilities.

virt-viewer-0.0.2-2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Virtual Machine Viewer

Description:

Virtual Machine Viewer provides a graphical console client for


connecting
to virtual machines. It uses the GTK-VNC widget to provide the
display,
and libvirt for looking up VNC server details.

wacomexpresskeys-0.4.1-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Wacom ExpressKeys and Touch Strips configuration utility

Description:

Configuration utility to bind Wacom tablet's ExpressKeys and Touch


Strips to
generate other input events.

wdaemon-0.14-2

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Hotplug helper for Wacom X.org driver

Description:

Helper application which emulates persistent input devices for


Wacom tablets
so they can be plugged and unplugged while X.org server is
running. This should
go away as soon X.org properly supports hotplugging.

xulrunner-1.9.0.5-1.el5_2

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: XUL Runtime for Gecko Applications

Description:

63
5.3 Release Notes

XULRunner provides the XUL Runtime environment for Gecko


applications.

yum-updatesd-0.9-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Update notification daemon

Description:

yum-updatesd provides a daemon which checks for available updates


and
can notify you when they are available via email, syslog or dbus.

11. Dropped Packages


cachefilesd-0.8-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: CacheFiles userspace management daemon

Description:

The cachefilesd daemon manages the caching files and directory


that are
that are used by network filesystems such a AFS and NFS to
do persistent caching to the local disk.

frysk-0.0.1.2007.06.21.rh2-4.el5

Group: Development/System

Summary: Frysk execution analysis tool

Description:

Frysk is an execution-analysis technology implemented using native


Java and C++.
It is aimed at providing developers and sysadmins with the ability
to both
examine and analyze running multi-host, multi-process, multi-
threaded systems.
Frysk allows the monitoring of running processes and threads, of
locking
primitives and will also expose deadlocks, gather data and debug
any given
process in the system.

gfs2-kmod-1.52-1.16.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: gfs2 kernel module

64
12. Updated Packages

Description:

GFS2 - The GFS2 filesystem provided for RHEL5.

sysreport-1.4.3-13.el5

Group: Development/Debuggers

Summary: Gathers system hardware and configuration information.

Description:

Sysreport is a utility that gathers information about a system's


hardware and configuration. The information can then be used for
diagnostic purposes and debugging. Sysreport is commonly used to
help
support technicians and developers by providing a "snapshot" of a
system's current layout.

12. Updated Packages

Cluster_Administration-5.1.0-7 - Cluster_Administration-5.2-1

Group: Documentation

Summary: Red Hat Cluster for Red Hat Enterprise Linux

Description:

Configuring and Managing a Red Hat Cluster describes the


configuration and management of Red Hat cluster systems
for Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5.2 It does not include information
about Red Hat Linux
Virtual Servers (LVS). Information about installing and
configuring
LVS is in a separate document.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

Deployment_Guide-5.1.0-11 - Deployment_Guide-5.2-11

Group: Documentation

Summary: Deployment Guide

Description:

This Deployment Guide documents relevant information regarding the


deployment, configuration and administration of Red Hat Enterprise
Linux
5.2.

No added dependencies

65
5.3 Release Notes

No removed dependencies

Global_File_System-5.1.0-6 - Global_File_System-5.2-1

Group: Documentation

Summary: Red Hat Global File System

Description:

This book provides information about installing, configuring, and


maintaining Red Hat GFS (Red Hat Global File System) for Red Hat
Enterprise Linux 5.2.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ImageMagick-6.2.8.0-3.el5.4 - ImageMagick-6.2.8.0-4.el5_1.1

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: An X application for displaying and manipulating images.

Description:

ImageMagick(TM) is an image display and manipulation tool for the


X
Window System. ImageMagick can read and write JPEG, TIFF, PNM,
GIF,
and Photo CD image formats. It can resize, rotate, sharpen, color
reduce, or add special effects to an image, and when finished you
can
either save the completed work in the original format or a
different
one. ImageMagick also includes command line programs for creating
animated or transparent .gifs, creating composite images, creating
thumbnail images, and more.

ImageMagick is one of your choices if you need a program to


manipulate
and dis play images. If you want to develop your own applications
which use ImageMagick code or APIs, you need to install
ImageMagick-devel as well.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

NetworkManager-0.6.4-6.el5 - NetworkManager-0.7.0-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Network connection manager and user applications

Description:

NetworkManager attempts to keep an active network connection

66
12. Updated Packages

available at all
times. It is intended only for the desktop use-case, and is not
intended for
usage on servers. The point of NetworkManager is to make
networking
configuration and setup as painless and automatic as possible. If
using DHCP,
NetworkManager is intended to replace default routes, obtain IP
addresses
from a DHCP server, and change nameservers whenever it sees fit.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

dbus-devel >= 1.1

dbus-glib-devel >= 0.73-6

dhclient

doxygen

gtk-doc

intltool

libdaemon-devel

libnotify-devel >= 0.4.2

libtool

nss-devel >= 3.11.7

perl(XML::Parser)

ppp >= 2.2.4

wireless-tools-devel >= 1:28-2

Removed Dependencies:

dbus-devel >= 0.90

dbus-glib-devel >= 0.70

dhcdbd

gnome-panel-devel

libgnomeui-devel

libnl-devel

libnotify-devel >= 0.3

perl-XML-Parser

wireless-tools-devel >= 1:28-0pre9

67
5.3 Release Notes

ORBit2-2.14.3-4.el5 - ORBit2-2.14.3-5.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: A high-performance CORBA Object Request Broker

Description:

ORBit is a high-performance CORBA (Common Object Request Broker


Architecture) ORB (object request broker). It allows programs to
send requests and receive replies from other programs, regardless
of the locations of the two programs. CORBA is an architecture
that
enables communication between program objects, regardless of the
programming language they're written in or the operating system
they
run on.

You will need to install this package and ORBit-devel if you want
to
write programs that use CORBA technology.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

OpenIPMI-2.0.6-5.el5.4 - OpenIPMI-2.0.6-11.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: OpenIPMI (Intelligent Platform Management Interface) library


and tools

Description:

The Open IPMI project aims to develop an open code base to allow
access to
platform information using Intelligent Platform Management
Interface (IPMI).
This package contains the tools of the OpenIPMI project.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

SysVinit-2.86-14 - SysVinit-2.86-15.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Programs which control basic system processes.

Description:

The SysVinit package contains a group of processes that control


the very basic functions of your system. SysVinit includes the
init
program, the first program started by the Linux kernel when the

68
12. Updated Packages

system boots. Init then controls the startup, running, and shutdown
of all other programs.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

Virtualization-5.1.0-12 - Virtualization-5.2-11

Group: Documentation

Summary: Virtualization Guide

Description:

The Red Hat Enterprise Linux Virtualization Guide contains


information on installation, configuring, administering, tips,
tricks and troubleshooting virtualization technologies used in Red
Hat Enterprise Linux.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

a2ps-4.13b-57.1.el5 - a2ps-4.13b-57.2.el5

Group: Applications/Publishing

Summary: Converts text and other types of files to PostScript(TM).

Description:

The a2ps filter converts text and other types of files to


PostScript(TM).
A2ps has pretty-printing capabilities and includes support for a
wide
number of programming languages, encodings (ISO Latins, Cyrillic,
etc.),
and medias.

Added Dependencies:

psutils

No removed dependencies

acl-2.2.39-2.1.el5 - acl-2.2.39-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Access control list utilities.

Description:

This package contains the getfacl and setfacl utilities needed for
manipulating access control lists.

No added dependencies

69
5.3 Release Notes

No removed dependencies

acpid-1.0.4-5 - acpid-1.0.4-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: ACPI Event Daemon

Description:

acpid is a daemon that dispatches ACPI events to user-space


programs.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

alsa-lib-1.0.14-1.rc4.el5 - alsa-lib-1.0.17-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) library.

Description:

The Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) provides audio and


MIDI
functionality to the Linux operating system.

This package includes the ALSA runtime libraries to simplify


application
programming and provide higher level functionality as well as
support for
the older OSS API, providing binary compatibility for most OSS
programs.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

alsa-utils-1.0.14-2.rc4.el5 - alsa-utils-1.0.17-1.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) utilities

Description:

This package contains command line utilities for the Advanced


Linux Sound
Architecture (ALSA).

Added Dependencies:

alsa-lib-devel >= 1.0.17

Removed Dependencies:

70
12. Updated Packages

alsa-lib-devel >= 1.0.14

amtu-1.0.4-4 - amtu-1.0.6-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Abstract Machine Test Utility (AMTU)

Description:

Abstract Machine Test Utility (AMTU) is an administrative utility


to check
whether the underlying protection mechanism of the hardware are
still being
enforced. This is a requirement of the Controlled Access
Protection Profile
FPT_AMT.1, see
http://www.radium.ncsc.mil/tpep/library/protection_profiles/CAPP-
1.d.pdf

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

anaconda-11.1.2.87-1 - anaconda-11.1.2.168-1

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Graphical system installer

Description:

The anaconda package contains the program which was used to


install your
system. These files are of little use on an already installed
system.

Added Dependencies:

iscsi-initiator-utils >= 6.2.0.868-0.9

kudzu-devel >= 1.2.57.1.18

libdhcp-devel >= 1.20-5

libnl-devel >= 1.0-0.10.pre5.5

Removed Dependencies:

glib2-devel >= 2.11.1-5

kudzu-devel >= 1.2.57.1.15

libdhcp-devel >= 1.16

apr-util-1.2.7-6 - apr-util-1.2.7-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

71
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: Apache Portable Runtime Utility library

Description:

The mission of the Apache Portable Runtime (APR) is to provide a


free library of C data structures and routines. This library
contains additional utility interfaces for APR; including support
for XML, LDAP, database interfaces, URI parsing and more.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

at-spi-1.7.11-2.fc6 - at-spi-1.7.11-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Assistive Technology Service Provider Interface

Description:

at-spi allows assistive technologies to access GTK-based


applications. Essentially it exposes the internals of applications
for
automation, so tools such as screen readers, magnifiers, or even
scripting interfaces can query and interact with GUI controls.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

audit-1.5.5-7.el5 - audit-1.7.7-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: User space tools for 2.6 kernel auditing

Description:

The audit package contains the user space utilities for


storing and searching the audit records generate by
the audit subsystem in the Linux 2.6 kernel.

Added Dependencies:

openldap-devel

tcp_wrappers

No removed dependencies

authconfig-5.3.12-2.el5 - authconfig-5.3.21-5.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Command line tool for setting up authentication from network


services

72
12. Updated Packages

Description:

Authconfig is a command line utility which can configure a


workstation
to use shadow (more secure) passwords. Authconfig can also
configure a
system to be a client for certain networked user information and
authentication schemes.

Added Dependencies:

python >= 2.4.1

Removed Dependencies:

python

autofs-5.0.1-0.rc2.55 - autofs-5.0.1-0.rc2.102

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: A tool for automatically mounting and unmounting filesystems.

Description:

autofs is a daemon which automatically mounts filesystems when you


use
them, and unmounts them later when you are not using them. This
can
include network filesystems, CD-ROMs, floppies, and so forth.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

bash-3.1-16.1 - bash-3.2-24.el5

Group: System Environment/Shells

Summary: The GNU Bourne Again shell (bash) version 3.2

Description:

The GNU Bourne Again shell (Bash) is a shell or command language


interpreter that is compatible with the Bourne shell (sh). Bash
incorporates useful features from the Korn shell (ksh) and the C
shell
(csh). Most sh scripts can be run by bash without modification.
This
package (bash) contains bash version 3.2, which improves POSIX
compliance over previous versions.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

gettext

73
5.3 Release Notes

No removed dependencies

bind-9.3.3-10.el5 - bind-9.3.4-10.P1.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The Berkeley Internet Name Domain (BIND) DNS (Domain Name
System) server.

Description:

BIND (Berkeley Internet Name Domain) is an implementation of the


DNS
(Domain Name System) protocols. BIND includes a DNS server
(named),
which resolves host names to IP addresses; a resolver library
(routines for applications to use when interfacing with DNS); and
tools for verifying that the DNS server is operating properly.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

binutils-2.17.50.0.6-5.el5 - binutils-2.17.50.0.6-9.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: A GNU collection of binary utilities.

Description:

Binutils is a collection of binary utilities, including ar (for


creating, modifying and extracting from archives), as (a family of
GNU
assemblers), gprof (for displaying call graph profile data), ld
(the
GNU linker), nm (for listing symbols from object files), objcopy
(for
copying and translating object files), objdump (for displaying
information from object files), ranlib (for generating an index
for
the contents of an archive), size (for listing the section sizes
of an
object or archive file), strings (for listing printable strings
from
files), strip (for discarding symbols), and addr2line (for
converting
addresses to file and line).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

bluez-libs-3.7-1 - bluez-libs-3.7-1.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Bluetooth libraries

74
12. Updated Packages

Description:

Libraries for use in Bluetooth applications.

The BLUETOOTH trademarks are owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., U.S.A.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

bluez-utils-3.7-2 - bluez-utils-3.7-2.2

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Bluetooth utilities

Description:

Bluetooth utilities (bluez-utils):


- hcitool
- hciattach
- hciconfig
- hcid
- l2ping
- start scripts (Red Hat)
- pcmcia configuration files

The BLUETOOTH trademarks are owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., U.S.A.

Added Dependencies:

bluez-libs-devel >= 3.7-1.1

Removed Dependencies:

bluez-libs-devel >= 3.7

booty-0.80.4-5 - booty-0.80.6-5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: simple python bootloader config lib

Description:

Small python library for use with bootloader configuration by


anaconda
and up2date.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

busybox-1.2.0-3 - busybox-1.2.0-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Shells

75
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: Statically linked binary providing simplified versions of


system commands

Description:

Busybox is a single binary which includes versions of a large


number
of system commands, including a shell. This package can be very
useful for recovering from certain types of system failures,
particularly those involving broken shared libraries.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

bzip2-1.0.3-3 - bzip2-1.0.3-4.el5_2

Group: Applications/File

Summary: A file compression utility.

Description:

Bzip2 is a freely available, patent-free, high quality data


compressor.
Bzip2 compresses files to within 10 to 15 percent of the
capabilities
of the best techniques available. However, bzip2 has the added
benefit
of being approximately two times faster at compression and six
times
faster at decompression than those techniques. Bzip2 is not the
fastest compression utility, but it does strike a balance between
speed
and compression capability.

Install bzip2 if you need a compression utility.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

cairo-1.2.4-2.el5 - cairo-1.2.4-5.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A vector graphics library

Description:

Cairo is a vector graphics library designed to provide high-


quality
display and print output. Currently supported output targets
include
the X Window System, OpenGL (via glitz), in-memory image buffers,
and
image files (PDF, PostScript, and SVG). Cairo is designed to

76
12. Updated Packages

produce
identical output on all output media while taking advantage of
display
hardware acceleration when available (eg. through the X Render
Extension or OpenGL).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ccid-1.0.1-6.el5 - ccid-1.3.8-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Generic USB CCID smart card reader driver

Description:

Generic USB CCID (Chip/Smart Card Interface Devices) driver.

Added Dependencies:

pcsc-lite-devel >= 1.3.3

Removed Dependencies:

pcsc-lite-devel >= %{pcsc-lite_ver}

cdrtools-2.01-10 - cdrtools-2.01-10.7.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A collection of CD/DVD utilities.

Description:

cdrtools is a collection of CD/DVD utilities.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

checkpolicy-1.33.1-2.el5 - checkpolicy-1.33.1-4.el5

Group: Development/System

Summary: SELinux policy compiler

Description:

Security-enhanced Linux is a feature of the Linux® kernel and a


number
of utilities with enhanced security functionality designed to add
mandatory access controls to Linux. The Security-enhanced Linux
kernel contains new architectural components originally developed
to
improve the security of the Flask operating system. These
architectural components provide general support for the

77
5.3 Release Notes

enforcement
of many kinds of mandatory access control policies, including
those
based on the concepts of Type Enforcement®, Role-based Access
Control, and Multi-level Security.

This package contains checkpolicy, the SELinux policy compiler.


Only required for building policies.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

chkconfig-1.3.30.1-1 - chkconfig-1.3.30.1-2

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A system tool for maintaining the /etc/rc*.d hierarchy.

Description:

Chkconfig is a basic system utility. It updates and queries


runlevel
information for system services. Chkconfig manipulates the
numerous
symbolic links in /etc/rc.d, to relieve system administrators of
some
of the drudgery of manually editing the symbolic links.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

clustermon-0.10.0-5.el5 - clustermon-0.12.1-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Monitoring and management of Red Hat Enterprise Linux Cluster


Suite

Description:

This package contains Red Hat Enterprise Linux Cluster Suite


SNMP/CIM module/agent/provider.

Added Dependencies:

cman-devel

No removed dependencies

cman-2.0.73-1.el5 - cman-2.0.98-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: cman - The Cluster Manager

Description:

78
12. Updated Packages

cman - The Cluster Manager

Added Dependencies:

kernel-headers

No removed dependencies

conga-0.10.0-6.el5 - conga-0.12.1-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Remote Management System

Description:

Conga is a project developing management system for remote


stations.
It consists of luci, https frontend, and ricci, secure daemon that
dispatches
incoming messages to underlying management modules.

No added dependencies

Removed Dependencies:

cman-devel

control-center-2.16.0-14.el5 - control-center-2.16.0-16.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: GNOME Control Center

Description:

GNOME (the GNU Network Object Model Environment) is an attractive


and
easy-to-use GUI desktop environment. The control-center package
provides the GNOME Control Center utilities that allow you to
setup
and configure your system's GNOME environment (things like the
desktop
background and theme, the screensaver, system sounds, and mouse
behavior).

If you install GNOME, you need to install control-center.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

coolkey-1.1.0-5.el5 - coolkey-1.1.0-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: CoolKey PKCS #11 module

79
5.3 Release Notes

Description:

Linux Driver support for the CoolKey and CAC products.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

coreutils-5.97-12.1.el5 - coreutils-5.97-19.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The GNU core utilities: a set of tools commonly used in shell
scripts

Description:

These are the GNU core utilities. This package is the combination
of
the old GNU fileutils, sh-utils, and textutils packages.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

cpufreq-utils-002-1.1.43.el5 - cpufreq-utils-005-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: CPU Frequency changing related utilities

Description:

cpufreq-utils contains several utilities that can be used to


control
the cpufreq interface provided by the kernel on hardware that
supports CPU frequency scaling.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

cpuspeed-1.2.1-1.48.el5 - cpuspeed-1.2.1-5.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: CPU frequency adjusting daemon

Description:

cpuspeed is a daemon that dynamically changes the speed


of your processor(s) depending upon its current workload
if it is capable (needs Intel Speedstep, AMD PowerNow!,
or similar support).

This package also supports enabling cpu frequency scaling


via in-kernel governors on Intel Centrino and AMD
Athlon64/Opteron platforms.

80
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

crash-4.0-4.6.1 - crash-4.0-7.2.3

Group: Development/Debuggers

Summary: crash utility for live systems; netdump, diskdump, kdump,


LKCD or mcore dumpfiles

Description:

The core analysis suite is a self-contained tool that can be used


to
investigate either live systems, kernel core dumps created from
the
netdump, diskdump and kdump packages from Red Hat Linux, the mcore
kernel patch
offered by Mission Critical Linux, or the LKCD kernel patch.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

createrepo-0.4.4-2.fc6 - createrepo-0.4.11-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Creates a common metadata repository

Description:

This utility will generate a common metadata repository from a


directory of rpm
packages.

Added Dependencies:

python

No removed dependencies

crypto-utils-2.3-1 - crypto-utils-2.3-2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: SSL certificate and key management utilities

Description:

This package provides tools for managing and generating


SSL certificates and keys.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

81
5.3 Release Notes

cryptsetup-luks-1.0.3-2.2.el5 - cryptsetup-luks-1.0.3-4.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A utility for setting up encrypted filesystems

Description:

This package contains cryptsetup, a utility for setting up


encrypted filesystems using Device Mapper and the dm-crypt target.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

cups-1.2.4-11.14.el5 - cups-1.3.7-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Common Unix Printing System

Description:

The Common UNIX Printing System provides a portable printing layer


for
UNIX® operating systems. It has been developed by Easy Software
Products
to promote a standard printing solution for all UNIX vendors and
users.
CUPS provides the System V and Berkeley command-line interfaces.

Added Dependencies:

avahi-compat-libdns_sd-devel

krb5-devel

No removed dependencies

cyrus-imapd-2.3.7-1.1.el5 - cyrus-imapd-2.3.7-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: A high-performance mail server with IMAP, POP3, NNTP and


SIEVE support

Description:

The cyrus-imapd package contains the core of the Cyrus IMAP


server.
It is a scaleable enterprise mail system designed for use from
small to large enterprise environments using standards-based
internet mail technologies.

A full Cyrus IMAP implementation allows a seamless mail and


bulletin
board environment to be set up across multiple servers. It differs
from

82
12. Updated Packages

other IMAP server implementations in that it is run on "sealed"


servers, where users are not normally permitted to log in and have
no
system account on the server. The mailbox database is stored in
parts
of the filesystem that are private to the Cyrus IMAP server. All
user
access to mail is through software using the IMAP, POP3 or KPOP
protocols. It also includes support for virtual domains, NNTP,
mailbox annotations, and much more. The private mailbox database
design
gives the server large advantages in efficiency, scalability and
administratability. Multiple concurrent read/write connections to
the
same mailbox are permitted. The server supports access control
lists on
mailboxes and storage quotas on mailbox hierarchies.

The Cyrus IMAP server supports the IMAP4rev1 protocol described


in RFC 3501. IMAP4rev1 has been approved as a proposed standard.
It supports any authentication mechanism available from the SASL
library, imaps/pop3s/nntps (IMAP/POP3/NNTP encrypted using SSL and
TLSv1) can be used for security. The server supports single
instance
store where possible when an email message is addressed to
multiple
recipients, SIEVE provides server side email filtering.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dbus-1.0.0-6.el5 - dbus-1.1.2-12.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: D-BUS message bus

Description:

D-BUS is a system for sending messages between applications. It is


used both for the systemwide message bus service, and as a
per-user-login-session messaging facility.

Added Dependencies:

doxygen

libxslt

xmlto

No removed dependencies

dbus-glib-0.70-5 - dbus-glib-0.73-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

83
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: GLib bindings for D-Bus

Description:

D-Bus add-on library to integrate the standard D-Bus library with


the GLib thread abstraction and main loop.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

desktop-printing-0.19-20.el5 - desktop-printing-0.19-20.2.el5

Group: Applications/File

Summary: Desktop print icon

Description:

Desktop-printing contains eggcups, a program for user print job


notification and control.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

devhelp-0.12-11.el5 - devhelp-0.12-20.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: API document browser

Description:

An API document browser for GNOME 2.

Added Dependencies:

gecko-devel-unstable >= 1.9

Removed Dependencies:

gecko-devel = 1.8.0.12

device-mapper-1.02.20-1.el5 - device-mapper-1.02.28-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: device mapper library

Description:

This package contains the supporting userspace files (libdevmapper


and
dmsetup) for the device-mapper.

No added dependencies

84
12. Updated Packages

No removed dependencies

device-mapper-multipath-0.4.7-12.el5 - device-mapper-multipath-0.4.7-23.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tools to manage multipath devices using device-mapper.

Description:

device-mapper-multipath provides tools to manage multipath devices


by instructing the
device-mapper multipath kernel module what to do.
The tools are :
* multipath : Scan the system for multipath devices and assemble
them.
* multipathd : Detects when paths fail and execs multipath to
update things.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dhcdbd-2.2-1.el5 - dhcdbd-2.2-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: DHCP D-BUS daemon (dhcdbd) controls dhclient sessions with D-


BUS, stores and presents DHCP options.

Description:

dhcdbd provides a D-BUS interface to the ISC dhclient software.


The
daemon provides access to DHCP configuration operations and stores
those
options persistently. Other D-BUS applications can receive
notifications
of changes in the client's DHCP configuration.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dhcp-3.0.5-7.el5 - dhcp-3.0.5-18.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server and relay


agent.

Description:

DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) is a protocol which


allows
individual devices on an IP network to get their own network
configuration information (IP address, subnetmask, broadcast
address,

85
5.3 Release Notes

etc.) from a DHCP server. The overall purpose of DHCP is to make


it
easier to administer a large network. The dhcp package includes
the
ISC DHCP service and relay agent.

To use DHCP on your network, install a DHCP service (or relay


agent),
and on clients run a DHCP client daemon. The dhcp package provides
the ISC DHCP service and relay agent.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dhcpv6-0.10-33.el5 - dhcpv6-1.0.10-16.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: DHCPv6 - DHCP server and client for IPv6

Description:

Implements the Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) for


Internet
Protocol version 6 (IPv6) networks in accordance with RFC 3315:
Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol for IPv6 (DHCPv6). Consists of dhcp6s(8),
the server
DHCP daemon, and dhcp6r(8), the DHCPv6 relay agent.

Install this package if you want to support dynamic configuration


of IPv6
addresses and parameters on your IPv6 network.

Added Dependencies:

kernel-headers

Removed Dependencies:

openssl-devel

diffstat-1.41-1.2.2 - diffstat-1.41-1.2.3.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: A utility which provides statistics based on the output of


diff.

Description:

The diff command compares files line by line. Diffstat reads the
output of the diff command and displays a histogram of the
insertions,
deletions and modifications in each file. Diffstat is commonly
used
to provide a summary of the changes in large, complex patch files.

86
12. Updated Packages

Install diffstat if you need a program which provides a summary of


the
diff command's output. You'll need to also install diffutils.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

diffutils-2.8.1-15.2.2 - diffutils-2.8.1-15.2.3.el5

Group: Applications/Text

Summary: A GNU collection of diff utilities.

Description:

Diffutils includes four utilities: diff, cmp, diff3 and sdiff.


Diff
compares two files and shows the differences, line by line. The
cmp
command shows the offset and line numbers where two files differ,
or
cmp can show the characters that differ between the two files. The
diff3 command shows the differences between three files. Diff3 can
be
used when two people have made independent changes to a common
original; diff3 can produce a merged file that contains both sets
of
changes and warnings about conflicts. The sdiff command can be
used
to merge two files interactively.

Install diffutils if you need to compare text files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dmraid-1.0.0.rc13-4.el5 - dmraid-1.0.0.rc13-33.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: dmraid (Device-mapper RAID tool and library)

Description:

DMRAID supports RAID device discovery, RAID set activation and


display of
properties for ATARAID on Linux >= 2.4 using device-mapper.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dnsmasq-2.39-2.el5 - dnsmasq-2.45-1.el5_2.1

Group: System Environment/Daemons

87
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: A lightweight DHCP/caching DNS server

Description:

Dnsmasq is lightweight, easy to configure DNS forwarder and DHCP


server.
It is designed to provide DNS and, optionally, DHCP, to a small
network.
It can serve the names of local machines which are not in the
global
DNS. The DHCP server integrates with the DNS server and allows
machines
with DHCP-allocated addresses to appear in the DNS with names
configured
either in each host or in a central configuration file. Dnsmasq
supports
static and dynamic DHCP leases and BOOTP for network booting of
diskless
machines.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dosfstools-2.11-6.2.el5 - dosfstools-2.11-7.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Utilities for making and checking MS-DOS FAT filesystems on


Linux.

Description:

The dosfstools package includes the mkdosfs and dosfsck utilities,


which respectively make and check MS-DOS FAT filesystems on hard
drives or on floppies.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

dovecot-1.0-1.2.rc15.el5 - dovecot-1.0.7-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Dovecot Secure imap server

Description:

Dovecot is an IMAP server for Linux/UNIX-like systems, written


with security
primarily in mind. It also contains a small POP3 server. It
supports mail
in either of maildir or mbox formats.

No added dependencies

88
12. Updated Packages

No removed dependencies

dvgrab-2.0-1.2.2 - dvgrab-3.0-1.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: Utility to capture video from a DV camera

Description:

The dvgrab utility will capture digital video from a DV source on


the firewire
(IEEE-1394) bus.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

e2fsprogs-1.39-10.el5 - e2fsprogs-1.39-20.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Utilities for managing the second and third extended


(ext2/ext3) filesystems

Description:

The e2fsprogs package contains a number of utilities for creating,


checking, modifying, and correcting any inconsistencies in second
and third extended (ext2/ext3) filesystems. E2fsprogs contains
e2fsck (used to repair filesystem inconsistencies after an unclean
shutdown), mke2fs (used to initialize a partition to contain an
empty ext2 filesystem), debugfs (used to examine the internal
structure of a filesystem, to manually repair a corrupted
filesystem, or to create test cases for e2fsck), tune2fs (used to
modify filesystem parameters), and most of the other core ext2fs
filesystem utilities.

You should install the e2fsprogs package if you need to manage the
performance of an ext2 and/or ext3 filesystem.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

eclipse-3.2.1-18.el5 - eclipse-3.2.1-19.el5

Group: Text Editors/Integrated Development Environments (IDE)

Summary: An open, extensible IDE

Description:

The Eclipse Platform is designed for building integrated


development
environments (IDEs) that can be used to create applications as
diverse

89
5.3 Release Notes

as web sites, embedded Java(tm) programs, C++ programs, and


Enterprise
JavaBeans(tm).

No added dependencies

Removed Dependencies:

firefox-devel

nspr-devel

ed-0.2-38.2.2 - ed-0.2-39.el5_2

Group: Applications/Text

Summary: The GNU line editor.

Description:

Ed is a line-oriented text editor, used to create, display, and


modify
text files (both interactively and via shell scripts). For most
purposes, ed has been replaced in normal usage by full-screen
editors
(emacs and vi, for example).

Ed was the original UNIX editor, and may be used by some programs.
In
general, however, you probably don't need to install it and you
probably
won't use it.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

edac-utils-0.9-5.el5 - edac-utils-0.9-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Userspace helper for kernel EDAC drivers

Description:

EDAC is the current set of drivers in the Linux kernel that handle
detection of ECC errors from memory controllers for most chipsets
on i386 and x86_64 architectures. This userspace component
consists
of an init script which makes sure EDAC drivers and DIMM labels
are loaded at system startup, as well as a library and utility
for reporting current error counts from the EDAC sysfs files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

elfutils-0.125-3.el5 - elfutils-0.137-3.el5

90
12. Updated Packages

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: A collection of utilities and DSOs to handle compiled objects

Description:

Elfutils is a collection of utilities, including ld (a linker),


nm (for listing symbols from object files), size (for listing the
section sizes of an object or archive file), strip (for discarding
symbols), readelf (to see the raw ELF file structures), and elflint
(to check for well-formed ELF files).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

emacs-21.4-19.el5 - emacs-21.4-20.el5

Group: Applications/Editors

Summary: GNU Emacs text editor

Description:

Emacs is a powerful, customizable, self-documenting, modeless text


editor. Emacs contains special code editing features, a scripting
language (elisp), and the capability to read mail, news, and more
without leaving the editor.

This package provides an emacs binary with support for X windows.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

emacspeak-23.0-2.1 - emacspeak-23.0-3.el5

Group: Applications/Editors

Summary: emacspeak -- The Complete Audio Desktop

Description:

Emacspeak is a speech interface that allows visually impaired


users to
interact independently and efficiently with the computer.
Emacspeak has
dramatically changed how the author and hundreds of blind and
visually
impaired users around the world interact with the personal
computer and
the Internet. A rich suite of task-oriented speech-enabled tools
provides
efficient speech-enabled access to the evolving semantic WWW.

91
5.3 Release Notes

When combined with Linux running on low-cost PC hardware,


Emacspeak/Linux provides a reliable, stable speech-friendly
solution that
opens up the Internet to visually impaired users around the world.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

enscript-1.6.4-4.1.el5 - enscript-1.6.4-4.1.1.el5_2

Group: Applications/Publishing

Summary: A plain ASCII to PostScript converter.

Description:

GNU enscript is a free replacement for Adobe's Enscript


program. Enscript converts ASCII files to PostScript(TM) and
spools
generated PostScript output to the specified printer or saves it
to a
file. Enscript can be extended to handle different output media
and
includes many options for customizing printouts.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

esc-1.0.0-32.el5 - esc-1.0.0-39.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Enterprise Security Client Smart Card Client

Description:

Enterprise Security Client allows the user to enroll and manage


their
cryptographic smartcards.

Added Dependencies:

xulrunner

xulrunner-devel

No removed dependencies

ethtool-5-1.el5 - ethtool-6-2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Ethernet settings tool for PCI ethernet cards

Description:

92
12. Updated Packages

This utility allows querying and changing of ethernet


card settings, such as speed, port, autonegotiation,
and PCI locations.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

evolution-data-server-1.8.0-25.el5 - evolution-data-server-1.12.3-6.el5_2.3

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Backend data server for Evolution

Description:

The evolution-data-server package provides a unified backend for


programs
that work with contacts, tasks, and calendar information.

It was originally developed for Evolution (hence the name), but is


now used
by other packages.

Added Dependencies:

gtk-doc

intltool >= 0.35.0

openldap-evolution-devel

openssl-devel

Removed Dependencies:

intltool

openldap-devel >= 2.0.11

file-4.17-9.0.1.el5 - file-4.17-15

Group: Applications/File

Summary: A utility for determining file types.

Description:

The file command is used to identify a particular file according


to the
type of data contained by the file. File can identify many
different
file types, including ELF binaries, system libraries, RPM
packages, and
different graphics formats.

93
5.3 Release Notes

You should install the file package, since the file command is
such a
useful utility.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

filesystem-2.4.0-1 - filesystem-2.4.0-2

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The basic directory layout for a Linux system.

Description:

The filesystem package is one of the basic packages that is


installed
on a Red Hat Linux system. Filesystem contains the basic directory
layout for a Linux operating system, including the correct
permissions
for the directories.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

findutils-4.2.27-4.1 - findutils-4.2.27-5.el5

Group: Applications/File

Summary: The GNU versions of find utilities (find and xargs).

Description:

The findutils package contains programs which will help you locate
files on your system. The find utility searches through a
hierarchy
of directories looking for files which match a certain set of
criteria
(such as a filename pattern). The xargs utility builds and
executes
command lines from standard input arguments (usually lists of file
names generated by the find command).

You should install findutils because it includes tools that are


very
useful for finding things on your system.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

firefox-1.5.0.12-3.el5 - firefox-3.0.5-1.el5_2

Group: Applications/Internet

94
12. Updated Packages

Summary: Mozilla Firefox Web browser

Description:

Mozilla Firefox is an open-source web browser, designed for


standards
compliance, performance and portability.

Added Dependencies:

startup-notification-devel

xulrunner-devel >= 1.9.0.5-1

xulrunner-devel-unstable >= 1.9.0.5-1

Removed Dependencies:

cairo-devel >= 0.5

libjpeg-devel

libpng-devel

nspr-devel >= 4.6

nss-devel >= 3.11.1

zlib-devel

firstboot-1.4.27.3-1.el5 - firstboot-1.4.27.7-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Initial system configuration utility

Description:

The firstboot utility runs after installation. It guides the


user through a series of steps that allows for easier
configuration of the machine.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

flac-1.1.2-27 - flac-1.1.2-28.el5_0.1

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: An encoder/decoder for the Free Lossless Audio Codec.

Description:

FLAC stands for Free Lossless Audio Codec. Grossly oversimplified,


FLAC
is similar to Ogg Vorbis, but lossless. The FLAC project consists
of
the stream format, reference encoders and decoders in library

95
5.3 Release Notes

form,
flac, a command-line program to encode and decode FLAC files,
metaflac,
a command-line metadata editor for FLAC files and input plugins
for
various music players.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

fontconfig-2.4.1-6.el5 - fontconfig-2.4.1-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Font configuration and customization library

Description:

Fontconfig is designed to locate fonts within the


system and select them according to requirements specified by
applications.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

fonts-indic-2.0.13-1.el5 - fonts-indic-2.3.1-1.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: Free Indian truetype/opentype fonts

Description:

This package provides the Hindi, Bengali, Gujarati, Punjabi, Tamil,


Kannada, Malayalam, Oriya, Telugu TrueType/Opentype fonts.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

freeradius-1.1.3-1.2.el5 - freeradius-1.1.3-1.4.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: High-performance and highly configurable free RADIUS server.

Description:

The FreeRADIUS Server Project is a high performance and highly


configurable
GPL'd free RADIUS server. The server is similar in some respects
to
Livingston's 2.0 server. While FreeRADIUS started as a variant of
the
Cistron RADIUS server, they don't share a lot in common any more.
It now has

96
12. Updated Packages

many more features than Cistron or Livingston, and is much more


configurable.

FreeRADIUS is an Internet authentication daemon, which implements


the RADIUS
protocol, as defined in RFC 2865 (and others). It allows Network
Access
Servers (NAS boxes) to perform authentication for dial-up users.
There are
also RADIUS clients available for Web servers, firewalls, Unix
logins, and
more. Using RADIUS allows authentication and authorization for a
network to
be centralized, and minimizes the amount of re-configuration which
has to be
done when adding or deleting new users.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

freetype-2.2.1-19.el5 - freetype-2.2.1-20.el5_2

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A free and portable font rendering engine

Description:

The FreeType engine is a free and portable font rendering


engine, developed to provide advanced font support for a variety
of
platforms and environments. FreeType is a library which can open
and
manages font files as well as efficiently load, hint and render
individual glyphs. FreeType is not a font server or a complete
text-rendering library.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ftp-0.17-33.fc6 - ftp-0.17-35.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: The standard UNIX FTP (File Transfer Protocol) client.

Description:

The ftp package provides the standard UNIX command-line FTP (File
Transfer Protocol) client. FTP is a widely used protocol for
transferring files over the Internet and for archiving files.

If your system is on a network, you should install ftp in order to


do
file transfers.

97
5.3 Release Notes

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gcc-4.1.2-14.el5 - gcc-4.1.2-44.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: Various compilers (C, C++, Objective-C, Java, ...)

Description:

The gcc package contains the GNU Compiler Collection version 4.1.
You'll need this package in order to compile C code.

Added Dependencies:

xulrunner-devel

Removed Dependencies:

firefox-devel

gd-2.0.33-9.3.fc6 - gd-2.0.33-9.4.el5_1.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A graphics library for quick creation of PNG or JPEG images

Description:

The gd graphics library allows your code to quickly draw images


complete with lines, arcs, text, multiple colors, cut and paste
from
other images, and flood fills, and to write out the result as a
PNG or
JPEG file. This is particularly useful in Web applications, where
PNG
and JPEG are two of the formats accepted for inline images by most
browsers. Note that gd is not a paint program.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gdb-6.5-25.el5 - gdb-6.8-27.el5

Group: Development/Debuggers

Summary: A GNU source-level debugger for C, C++, Java and other


languages

Description:

GDB, the GNU debugger, allows you to debug programs written in C,


C++,
Java, and other languages, by executing them in a controlled
fashion

98
12. Updated Packages

and printing their data.

Added Dependencies:

expat-devel

readline-devel

Removed Dependencies:

/lib/libc.so.6

/lib64/libc.so.6

/usr/lib/libc.so

/usr/lib64/libc.so

gdm-2.16.0-31.0.1.el5 - gdm-2.16.0-46.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: The GNOME Display Manager.

Description:

Gdm (the GNOME Display Manager) is a highly configurable


reimplementation of xdm, the X Display Manager. Gdm allows you to
log
into your system with the X Window System running and supports
running
several different X sessions on your local machine at the same
time.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gedit-2.16.0-5.el5 - gedit-2.16.0-9.el5

Group: Applications/Editors

Summary: gEdit is a small but powerful text editor for GNOME

Description:

gEdit is a small but powerful text editor designed specifically


for
the GNOME GUI desktop. gEdit includes a plug-in API (which
supports
extensibility while keeping the core binary small), support for
editing multiple documents using notebook tabs, and standard text
editor functions.

You'll need to have GNOME and GTK+ installed to use gEdit.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

99
5.3 Release Notes

gfs-kmod-0.1.19-7.el5 - gfs-kmod-0.1.31-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: gfs kernel modules

Description:

gfs - The Global File System is a symmetric, shared-disk, cluster


file
system.

Added Dependencies:

kernel-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-128.el5

kernel-xen-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-128.el5

Removed Dependencies:

kernel-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-53.el5

kernel-xen-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-53.el5

gfs-utils-0.1.12-1.el5 - gfs-utils-0.1.18-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: Utilities for managing the global filesystem (GFS)

Description:

The gfs-utils package contains a number of utilities for creating,


checking, modifying, and correcting any inconsistencies in GFS
filesystems.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gfs2-utils-0.1.38-1.el5 - gfs2-utils-0.1.53-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: Utilities for managing the global filesystem (GFS)

Description:

The gfs2-utils package contains a number of utilities for


creating,
checking, modifying, and correcting any inconsistencies in GFS
filesystems.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ghostscript-8.15.2-9.1.el5 - ghostscript-8.15.2-9.4.el5

Group: Applications/Publishing

100
12. Updated Packages

Group: Applications/Publishing

Summary: A PostScript(TM) interpreter and renderer.

Description:

Ghostscript is a set of software that provides a PostScript(TM)


interpreter, a set of C procedures (the Ghostscript library, which
implements the graphics capabilities in the PostScript language)
and
an interpreter for Portable Document Format (PDF) files.
Ghostscript
translates PostScript code into many common, bitmapped formats,
like
those understood by your printer or screen. Ghostscript is
normally
used to display PostScript files and to print PostScript files to
non-PostScript printers.

If you need to display PostScript files or print them to


non-PostScript printers, you should install ghostscript. If you
install ghostscript, you also need to install the ghostscript-
fonts
package.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gimp-print-4.2.7-22 - gimp-print-4.2.7-22.2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A collection of high-quality printer drivers.

Description:

These drivers provide printing quality for UNIX/Linux in many


cases equal
to or better than proprietary vendor-supplied drivers, and can be
used for
many of the most demanding printing tasks.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

glibc-2.5-18 - glibc-2.5-34

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The GNU libc libraries.

Description:

The glibc package contains standard libraries which are used by


multiple programs on the system. In order to save disk space and
memory, as well as to make upgrading easier, common system code is

101
5.3 Release Notes

kept in one place and shared between programs. This particular


package
contains the most important sets of shared libraries: the standard
C
library and the standard math library. Without these two
libraries, a
Linux system will not function.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnbd-1.1.5-1.el5 - gnbd-1.1.7-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: GFS's Network Block Device

Description:

gnbd - GFS's Network Block Device

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnbd-kmod-0.1.4-12.el5 - gnbd-kmod-0.1.5-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: gnbd kernel modules

Description:

gnbd - The Global Network Block Device

Added Dependencies:

kernel-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-98.el5

kernel-xen-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-98.el5

Removed Dependencies:

kernel-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-53.el5

kernel-xen-devel-ia64 = 2.6.18-53.el5

gnome-panel-2.16.1-6.el5 - gnome-panel-2.16.1-7.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: GNOME panel

Description:

The GNOME panel provides the window list, workspace switcher,


menus, and other
features for the GNOME desktop.

102
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnome-power-manager-2.16.0-8.el5 - gnome-power-manager-2.16.0-10.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: GNOME Power Manager

Description:

GNOME Power Manager uses the information and facilities provided


by HAL
displaying icons and handling user callbacks in an interactive
GNOME session.
GNOME Power Preferences allows authorised users to set policy and
change preferences.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnome-python2-desktop-2.16.0-1.fc6 - gnome-python2-desktop-2.16.0-2.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: The sources for additional PyGNOME Python extension modules


for the GNOME desktop

Description:

The gnome-python-desktop package contains the source packages for


additional
Python bindings for GNOME. It should be used together with gnome-
python.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnome-python2-extras-2.14.2-4.fc6 - gnome-python2-extras-2.14.2-6.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: The sources for additional. PyGNOME Python extension modules.

Description:

The gnome-python-extra package contains the source packages for


additional
Python bindings for GNOME. It should be used together with gnome-
python.

Added Dependencies:

gecko-devel-unstable >= 1.9

103
5.3 Release Notes

Removed Dependencies:

firefox-devel >= 1.5.0.5

gnome-screensaver-2.16.1-5.el5 - gnome-screensaver-2.16.1-8.el5

Group: Amusements/Graphics

Summary: GNOME Screensaver

Description:

gnome-screensaver is a screen saver and locker that aims to have


simple, sane, secure defaults and be well integrated with the
desktop.

Added Dependencies:

libXxf86misc-devel

libXxf86vm-devel

No removed dependencies

gnome-terminal-2.16.0-3.el5 - gnome-terminal-2.16.0-5.3.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: GNOME Terminal

Description:

GNOME terminal emulator application.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnome-utils-2.16.0-3.el5 - gnome-utils-2.16.0-5.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: GNOME utility programs

Description:

GNOME (GNU Network Object Model Environment) is a user-friendly


set of
GUI applications and desktop tools to be used in conjunction with
a
window manager for the X Window System. The gnome-utils package
includes a set of small "desk accessory" utility applications for
GNOME.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

104
12. Updated Packages

gnome-volume-manager-2.15.0-4.el5 - gnome-volume-manager-2.15.0-5.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: The GNOME Volume Manager

Description:

The GNOME Volume Manager monitors volume-related events and


responds with
user-specified policy. The GNOME Volume Manager can automount hot-
plugged
drives, automount inserted removable media, autorun programs,
automatically
play audio CDs and video DVDs, and automatically import photos
from a digital
camera. The GNOME Volume Manager does this entirely in user-space
and without
polling.

The GNOME Voume Manager sits at the top end of a larger picture
that aims to
integrate the Linux system from the kernel on up through the
desktop and its
applications.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnupg-1.4.5-13 - gnupg-1.4.5-14

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A GNU utility for secure communication and data storage.

Description:

GnuPG (GNU Privacy Guard) is a GNU utility for encrypting data and
creating digital signatures. GnuPG has advanced key management
capabilities and is compliant with the proposed OpenPGP Internet
standard described in RFC2440. Since GnuPG doesn't use any
patented
algorithm, it is not compatible with any version of PGP2 (PGP2.x
uses
only IDEA for symmetric-key encryption, which is patented
worldwide).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gnuplot-4.0.0-12 - gnuplot-4.0.0-14.el5

Group: Applications/Engineering

Summary: A program for plotting mathematical expressions and data.

105
5.3 Release Notes

Description:

Gnuplot is a command-line driven, interactive function plotting


program especially suited for scientific data representation.
Gnuplot
can be used to plot functions and data points in both two and
three
dimensions and in many different formats.

Install gnuplot if you need a graphics package for scientific data


representation.

Added Dependencies:

gd-devel

No removed dependencies

gnutls-1.4.1-2 - gnutls-1.4.1-3.el5_2.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A TLS protocol implementation.

Description:

GnuTLS is a project that aims to develop a library which provides


a secure
layer, over a reliable transport layer. Currently the GnuTLS
library implements
the proposed standards by the IETF's TLS working group.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

grub-0.97-13 - grub-0.97-13.2

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: GRUB - the Grand Unified Boot Loader.

Description:

GRUB (Grand Unified Boot Loader) is an experimental boot loader


capable of booting into most free operating systems - Linux,
FreeBSD,
NetBSD, GNU Mach, and others as well as most commercial operating
systems.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gstreamer-0.10.9-3.el5 - gstreamer-0.10.20-3.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

106
12. Updated Packages

Summary: GStreamer streaming media framework runtime

Description:

GStreamer is a streaming media framework, based on graphs of


filters which
operate on media data. Applications using this library can do
anything
from real-time sound processing to playing videos, and just about
anything
else media-related. Its plugin-based architecture means that new
data
types or processing capabilities can be added simply by installing
new
plugins.

Added Dependencies:

PyXML

autoconf

automake

docbook-style-dsssl

docbook-style-xsl

docbook-utils

gettext-devel

ghostscript

jadetex

libtool

libxslt

netpbm-progs

openjade

python2

tetex-dvips

transfig

xfig

No removed dependencies

gstreamer-plugins-base-0.10.9-6.el5 - gstreamer-plugins-base-0.10.20-3.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: GStreamer streaming media framework base plug-ins

Description:

107
5.3 Release Notes

GStreamer is a streaming media framework, based on graphs of


filters which
operate on media data. Applications using this library can do
anything
from real-time sound processing to playing videos, and just about
anything
else media-related. Its plugin-based architecture means that new
data
types or processing capabilities can be added simply by installing
new
plug-ins.

This package contains a set of well-maintained base plug-ins.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

gnome-vfs2-devel

gstreamer-devel >= 0.10.20

Removed Dependencies:

gnome-vfs2-devel > 1.9.4.00

gstreamer-devel >= 0.10.6

liboil-devel >= 0.3.2

gstreamer-plugins-good-0.10.4-4.el5 - gstreamer-plugins-good-0.10.9-1.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: GStreamer plug-ins with good code and licensing

Description:

GStreamer is a streaming media framework, based on graphs of


filters which
operate on media data. Applications using this library can do
anything
from real-time sound processing to playing videos, and just about
anything
else media-related. Its plugin-based architecture means that new
data
types or processing capabilities can be added simply by installing
new
plug-ins.

GStreamer Good Plug-ins is a collection of well-supported plug-ins


of
good quality and under the LGPL license.

No added dependencies

108
12. Updated Packages

No removed dependencies

gthumb-2.7.8-5.el5 - gthumb-2.7.8-8.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: Image viewer, editor, organizer

Description:

gthumb is an application for viewing, editing, and organizing


collections of images.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gtk2-2.10.4-19.el5 - gtk2-2.10.4-20.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The GIMP ToolKit (GTK+), a library for creating GUIs for X

Description:

GTK+ is a multi-platform toolkit for creating graphical user


interfaces. Offering a complete set of widgets, GTK+ is suitable
for
projects ranging from small one-off tools to complete application
suites.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

gtkhtml3-3.12.0-1.fc6 - gtkhtml3-3.16.3-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: gtkhtml library

Description:

GtkHTML is a lightweight HTML rendering/printing/editing engine.


It
was originally based on KHTMLW, but is now being developed
independently of it.

Added Dependencies:

intltool >= 0.35.0

Removed Dependencies:

intltool

libgnomeprint22-devel >= 2.7.1

libgnomeprintui22-devel >= 2.7.1

109
5.3 Release Notes

gzip-1.3.5-9.el5 - gzip-1.3.5-10.el5

Group: Applications/File

Summary: The GNU data compression program.

Description:

The gzip package contains the popular GNU gzip data compression
program. Gzipped files have a .gz extension.

Gzip should be installed on your Red Hat Linux system, because it


is a
very commonly used data compression program.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

hal-0.5.8.1-25.el5 - hal-0.5.8.1-38.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Hardware Abstraction Layer

Description:

HAL is daemon for collection and maintaining information from


several
sources about the hardware on the system. It provides a live
device
list through D-BUS.

Added Dependencies:

gperf >= 3.0.1

No removed dependencies

hal-cups-utils-0.6.2-5 - hal-cups-utils-0.6.2-5.2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Halified CUPS utilities

Description:

Halified utilities for CUPS:


- hal_lpadmin
- hal CUPS backend

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

hplip-1.6.7-4.1.el5 - hplip-1.6.7-4.1.el5_2.4

Group: System Environment/Daemons

110
12. Updated Packages

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: HP Linux Imaging and Printing Project

Description:

The Hewlett-Packard Linux Imaging and Printing Project provides


drivers for HP printers and multi-function peripherals.

Added Dependencies:

openssl-devel

No removed dependencies

htdig-3.2.0b6-9.el5 - htdig-3.2.0b6-9.0.1.el5_1

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: ht://Dig - Web search engine

Description:

The ht://Dig system is a complete world wide web indexing and


searching
system for a small domain or intranet. This system is not meant to
replace
the need for powerful internet-wide search systems like Lycos,
Infoseek,
Webcrawler and AltaVista. Instead it is meant to cover the search
needs for
a single company, campus, or even a particular sub section of a
web site. As
opposed to some WAIS-based or web-server based search engines,
ht://Dig can
span several web servers at a site. The type of these different
web servers
doesn't matter as long as they understand the HTTP 1.0 protocol.
ht://Dig is also used by KDE to search KDE's HTML documentation.

ht://Dig was developed at San Diego State University as a way to


search the
various web servers on the campus network.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

htmlview-4.0.0-1.el5 - htmlview-4.0.0-2.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Launcher of Preferred Web Browser

Description:

htmlview and launchmail are tools for launching Preferred


Applications.

111
5.3 Release Notes

This package exists for compatibility reasons and is likely to be


removed
later when equivalent functionality is implemented elsewhere.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

httpd-2.2.3-11.el5 - httpd-2.2.3-22.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Apache HTTP Server

Description:

The Apache HTTP Server is a powerful, efficient, and extensible


web server.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

hwbrowser-0.30-1.el5 - hwbrowser-0.30-2.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A hardware browser.

Description:

A browser for your current hardware configuration.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

hwdata-0.211-1 - hwdata-0.213.11-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Hardware identification and configuration data

Description:

hwdata contains various hardware identification and configuration


data,
such as the pci.ids database and MonitorsDb databases.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ibutils-1.2-2.el5 - ibutils-1.2-9.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: OpenIB Mellanox InfiniBand Diagnostic Tools

112
12. Updated Packages

Description:

ibutils provides IB network and path diagnostics.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

libibumad-devel

libtool

opensm-devel >= 3.2.0

Removed Dependencies:

opensm-devel >= 3.0.3

icu-3.6-5.11 - icu-3.6-5.11.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: International Components for Unicode

Description:

The International Components for Unicode (ICU) libraries provide


robust and full-featured Unicode services on a wide variety of
platforms. ICU supports the most current version of the Unicode
standard, and they provide support for supplementary Unicode
characters (needed for GB 18030 repertoire support).
As computing environments become more heterogeneous, software
portability becomes more important. ICU lets you produce the same
results across all the various platforms you support, without
sacrificing performance. It offers great flexibility to extend and
customize the supplied services.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

initscripts-8.45.17.EL-1 - initscripts-8.45.25-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The inittab file and the /etc/init.d scripts.

Description:

The initscripts package contains the basic system scripts used to


boot
your Red Hat system, change runlevels, and shut the system down
cleanly. Initscripts also contains the scripts that activate and
deactivate most network interfaces.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

113
5.3 Release Notes

inn-2.4.3-6.fc6 - inn-2.4.3-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The InterNetNews (INN) system, an Usenet news server.

Description:

INN (InterNetNews) is a complete system for serving Usenet news


and/or
private newsfeeds. INN includes innd, an NNTP (NetNews Transport
Protocol) server, and nnrpd, a newsreader that is spawned for each
client. Both innd and nnrpd vary slightly from the NNTP protocol,
but
not in ways that are easily noticed.

Install the inn package if you need a complete system for serving
and
reading Usenet news. You may also need to install inn-devel, if
you
are going to use a separate program which interfaces to INN, like
newsgate or tin.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

iproute-2.6.18-4.el5 - iproute-2.6.18-9.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Advanced IP routing and network device configuration tools.

Description:

The iproute package contains networking utilities (ip and rtmon,


for
example) which are designed to use the advanced networking
capabilities of the Linux 2.4.x and 2.6.x kernel.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

iprutils-2.2.6-1.el5 - iprutils-2.2.8-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Utilities for the IBM Power Linux RAID adapters

Description:

Provides a suite of utilities to manage and configure SCSI devices


supported by the ipr SCSI storage device driver.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

114
12. Updated Packages

ipsec-tools-0.6.5-8.el5 - ipsec-tools-0.6.5-13.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tools for configuring and using IPSEC

Description:

This is the IPsec-Tools package. You need this package in order to


really use the IPsec functionality in the linux-2.5+ kernels. This
package builds:

- setkey, a program to directly manipulate policies and SAs


- racoon, an IKEv1 keying daemon

Added Dependencies:

kernel-headers >= 2.6.18-92

No removed dependencies

iptables-1.3.5-1.2.1 - iptables-1.3.5-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tools for managing Linux kernel packet filtering


capabilities.

Description:

The iptables utility controls the network packet filtering code in


the
Linux kernel. If you need to set up firewalls and/or IP
masquerading,
you should install this package.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

iputils-20020927-43.el5 - iputils-20020927-45.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Network monitoring tools including ping.

Description:

The iputils package contains basic utilities for monitoring a


network,
including ping. The ping command sends a series of ICMP protocol
ECHO_REQUEST packets to a specified network host to discover
whether
the target machine is alive and receiving network traffic.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

115
5.3 Release Notes

irqbalance-0.55-6.el5 - irqbalance-0.55-10.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: IRQ balancing daemon.

Description:

irqbalance is a daemon that evenly distributes IRQ load across


multiple CPUs for enhanced performance.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

iscsi-initiator-utils-6.2.0.865-0.8.el5 - iscsi-initiator-utils-6.2.0.868-0.18.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: iSCSI daemon and utility programs

Description:

The iscsi package provides the server daemon for the iSCSI
protocol,
as well as the utility programs used to manage it. iSCSI is a
protocol
for distributed disk access using SCSI commands sent over Internet
Protocol networks.

Added Dependencies:

bison

flex

No removed dependencies

isdn4k-utils-3.2-50.1 - isdn4k-utils-3.2-51.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Utilities for configuring an ISDN subsystem.

Description:

The isdn4k-utils package contains a collection of utilities needed


for
configuring an ISDN subsystem.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

jakarta-commons-collections-3.1-6jpp.1 - jakarta-commons-collections-3.2-2jpp.3

Group: Development/Libraries/Java

Summary: Jakarta Commons Collections Package

116
12. Updated Packages

Description:

The introduction of the Collections API by Sun in JDK 1.2 has been
a
boon to quick and effective Java programming. Ready access to
powerful
data structures has accelerated development by reducing the need
for
custom container classes around each core object. Most Java2 APIs
are
significantly easier to use because of the Collections API.
However, there are certain holes left unfilled by Sun's
implementations, and the Jakarta-Commons Collections Component
strives
to fulfill them. Among the features of this package are:
- special-purpose implementations of Lists and Maps for fast
access
- adapter classes from Java1-style containers (arrays,
enumerations) to
Java2-style collections.
- methods to test or create typical set-theory properties of
collections
such as union, intersection, and closure.

Added Dependencies:

xml-commons-apis >= 1.3

No removed dependencies

java-1.4.2-gcj-compat-1.4.2.0-40jpp.112 - java-1.4.2-gcj-compat-1.4.2.0-40jpp.115

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: JPackage runtime scripts for GCJ

Description:

This package installs directory structures, shell scripts and


symbolic
links to simulate a JPackage-compatible runtime environment with
GCJ.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

kbd-1.12-19.el5 - kbd-1.12-21.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tools for configuring the console (keyboard, virtual


terminals, etc.)

Description:

117
5.3 Release Notes

The kbd package contains tools for managing a Linux


system's console's behavior, including the keyboard, the screen
fonts, the virtual terminals and font files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

kdeadmin-3.5.4-2.fc6 - kdeadmin-3.5.4-3.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: Administrative tools for KDE.

Description:

The kdeadmin package includes administrative tools for the K


Desktop
Environment (KDE) including:

kcron - Crontab editor


kdat - Tape backup tool
kuser - Frontend for configuring users and user groups

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

kdebase-3.5.4-13.6.el5 - kdebase-3.5.4-19.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: K Desktop Environment - core files

Description:

Core applications for the K Desktop Environment. Included are: kdm


(replacement for xdm), kwin (window manager), konqueror
(filemanager,
web browser, ftp client, ...), konsole (xterm replacement), kpanel
(application starter and desktop pager), kaudio (audio server),
kdehelp (viewer for kde help files, info and man pages), kthememgr
(system for managing alternate theme packages) plus other KDE
components (kcheckpass, kikbd, kscreensaver, kcontrol, kfind,
kfontmanager, kmenuedit).

Added Dependencies:

libutempter-devel

No removed dependencies

kdebindings-3.5.4-1.fc6 - kdebindings-3.5.4-6.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: KDE bindings to non-C++ languages

118
12. Updated Packages

Description:

KDE/DCOP bindings to non-C++ languages

Added Dependencies:

libutempter-devel

perl >= 5.8.8

Removed Dependencies:

perl >= 5.8

kdelibs-3.5.4-13.el5 - kdelibs-3.5.4-18.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: K Desktop Environment - Libraries

Description:

Libraries for the K Desktop Environment:


KDE Libraries included: kdecore (KDE core library), kdeui (user
interface),
kfm (file manager), khtmlw (HTML widget), kio (Input/Output,
networking),
kspell (spelling checker), jscript (javascript), kab
(addressbook),
kimgio (image manipulation).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

kdenetwork-3.5.4-4.fc6 - kdenetwork-3.5.4-8.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: K Desktop Environment - Network Applications

Description:

Networking applications for the K Desktop Environment.

Added Dependencies:

libutempter-devel

No removed dependencies

kernel-2.6.18-53.el5 - kernel-2.6.18-128.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: The Linux kernel (the core of the Linux operating system)

Description:

119
5.3 Release Notes

The kernel package contains the Linux kernel (vmlinuz), the core
of any
Linux operating system. The kernel handles the basic functions
of the operating system: memory allocation, process allocation,
device
input and output, etc.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

kexec-tools-1.101-194.4.el5 - kexec-tools-1.102pre-56.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: The kexec/kdump userspace component.

Description:

kexec-tools provides /sbin/kexec binary that facilitates a new


kernel to boot using the kernel's kexec feature either on a
normal or a panic reboot. This package contains the /sbin/kexec
binary and ancillary utilities that together form the userspace
component of the kernel's kexec feature.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

krb5-1.6.1-17.el5 - krb5-1.6.1-31.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The Kerberos network authentication system.

Description:

Kerberos V5 is a trusted-third-party network authentication


system,
which can improve your network's security by eliminating the
insecure
practice of cleartext passwords.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ksh-20060214-1.4 - ksh-20080202-2.el5

Group: Applications/Shells

Summary: The Original ATT Korn Shell

Description:

KSH-93 is the most recent version of the KornShell by David Korn


of
AT&T Bell Laboratories.

120
12. Updated Packages

KornShell is a shell programming language, which is upward


compatible
with "sh" (the Bourne Shell).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

kudzu-1.2.57.1.15-1 - kudzu-1.2.57.1.21-1

Group: Applications/System

Summary: The Red Hat Linux hardware probing tool.

Description:

Kudzu is a hardware probing tool run at system boot time to


determine
what hardware has been added or removed from the system.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

lam-7.1.2-8.fc6 - lam-7.1.2-14.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: The LAM (Local Area Multicomputer) programming environment.

Description:

LAM (Local Area Multicomputer) is an Message-Passing Interface


(MPI)
programming environment and development system for heterogeneous
computers on a network. With LAM/MPI, a dedicated cluster or an
existing network computing infrastructure can act as one parallel
computer to solve one problem. LAM/MPI is considered to be
"cluster
friendly" because it offers daemon-based process startup/control
as
well as fast client-to-client message passing protocols. LAM/MPI
can
use TCP/IP and/or shared memory for message passing (different
RPMs
are supplied for this -- see the main LAM website at
http://www.mpi.nd.edu/lam/ for details).<

LAM features a full implementation of MPI version 1 (with the


exception that LAM does not support cancelling of sends), and much
of
version 2. Compliant applications are source code portable between
LAM
and any other implementation of MPI. In addition to meeting the
standard, LAM/MPI offers extensive monitoring capabilities to
support
debugging. Monitoring happens on two levels: On one level, LAM/MPI

121
5.3 Release Notes

has
the hooks to allow a snapshot of a process and message status to
be
taken at any time during an application run. The status includes
all
aspects of synchronization plus datatype map/signature,
communicator
group membership and message contents (see the XMPI application on
the
main LAM website). On the second level, the MPI library can produce
a
cumulative record of communication, which can be visualized either
at
runtime or post-mortem.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libX11-1.0.3-8.0.1.el5 - libX11-1.0.3-9.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: X.Org X11 libX11 runtime library

Description:

X.Org X11 libX11 runtime library

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libXfont-1.2.2-1.0.2.el5 - libXfont-1.2.2-1.0.3.el5_1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: X.Org X11 libXfont runtime library

Description:

X.Org X11 libXfont runtime library

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libao-0.8.6-5 - libao-0.8.6-7

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Cross Platform Audio Output Library.

Description:

Libao is a cross platform audio output library. It currently


supports
ESD, OSS, Solaris, and IRIX.

122
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libchewing-0.3.0-7.el5 - libchewing-0.3.0-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Intelligent phonetic input method library for Traditional


Chinese

Description:

libchewing is an intelligent phonetic input method library for


Chinese.

It provides the core algorithm and logic that can be used by


various
input methods. The Chewing input method is a smart bopomofo
phonetics
input method that is useful for inputting Mandarin Chinese.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libdhcp-1.20-2.el5 - libdhcp-1.20-6.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A library for network interface configuration with DHCP

Description:

libdhcp enables programs to invoke and control the Dynamic Host


Configuration
Protocol (DHCP) clients: the Internet Software Consortium (ISC)
IPv4 DHCP
client library, libdhcp4client, and the IPv6 DHCPv6 client
library,
libdhcp6client, and provides Network Interface Configuration (NIC)
services
for network parameter autoconfiguration with DHCP.

Added Dependencies:

dhcp-devel >= 12:3.0.5-13

libdhcp4client-devel >= 12:3.0.5-13

libdhcp6client-devel >= 1.0.9-1

Removed Dependencies:

dhcp-devel

libdhcp4client-devel >= 12:3.0.4-17

123
5.3 Release Notes

libdhcp6client-devel

liberation-fonts-0.2-2.el5 - liberation-fonts-1.0-1.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: Fonts to replace commonly used Microsoft Windows Fonts

Description:

The Liberation Fonts are intended to be replacements for the three


most commonly used fonts on Microsoft systems: Times New Roman,
Arial, and Courier New.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libexif-0.6.13-4.0.2.el5 - libexif-0.6.13-4.0.2.el5_1.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Library for extracting extra information from image files

Description:

Most digital cameras produce EXIF files, which are JPEG files with
extra tags that contain information about the image. The EXIF
library
allows you to parse an EXIF file and read the data from those
tags.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libgcrypt-1.2.3-1 - libgcrypt-1.2.4-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A general-purpose cryptography library.

Description:

Libgcrypt is a general purpose crypto library based on the code


used
in GNU Privacy Guard. This is a development version.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libgnomeprint22-2.12.1-9.el5 - libgnomeprint22-2.12.1-10.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Printing library for GNOME.

Description:

124
12. Updated Packages

GNOME (GNU Network Object Model Environment) is a user-friendly


set of
applications and desktop tools to be used in conjunction with a
window
manager for the X Window System. The gnome-print package contains
libraries and fonts needed by GNOME applications for printing.

You should install the gnome-print package if you intend to use


any of
the GNOME applications that can print. If you would like to
develop
GNOME applications that can print you will also need to install
the
gnome-print devel package.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libhugetlbfs-1.0.1-1.el5 - libhugetlbfs-1.3-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Library to access the Huge TLB Filesystem

Description:

The libhugetlbfs library interacts with the Linux hugetlbfs to


make large pages
available to applications in a transparent manner.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libica-1.3.7-5.el5 - libica-1.3.7-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A library of functions for accessing ICA hardware crypto on


IBM zSeries

Description:

A library of functions for accessing ICA hardware crypto on IBM


zSeries

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

libtool

No removed dependencies

125
5.3 Release Notes

libnl-1.0-0.10.pre5.4 - libnl-1.0-0.10.pre5.5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Convenience library for kernel netlink sockets

Description:

This package contains a convenience library to simplify


using the Linux kernel's netlink sockets interface for
network manipulation

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libpng-1.2.10-7.0.2 - libpng-1.2.10-7.1.el5_0.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A library of functions for manipulating PNG image format


files

Description:

The libpng package contains a library of functions for creating


and
manipulating PNG (Portable Network Graphics) image format files.
PNG
is a bit-mapped graphics format similar to the GIF format. PNG was
created to replace the GIF format, since GIF uses a patented data
compression algorithm.

Libpng should be installed if you need to manipulate PNG format


image
files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libraw1394-1.2.1-1.fc6 - libraw1394-1.3.0-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Library providing low-level IEEE-1394 access

Description:

The libraw1394 library provides direct access to the IEEE-1394 bus


through
the Linux 1394 subsystem's raw1394 user space interface.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

126
12. Updated Packages

libtool

No removed dependencies

librtas-1.2.4-3.el5 - librtas-1.3.3-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Libraries to provide access to RTAS calls and RTAS events

Description:

The librtas shared library provides userspace with an interface


through which certain RTAS calls can be made. The library uses
either of the RTAS User Module or the RTAS system call to direct
the kernel in making these calls.

The librtasevent shared library provides users with a set of


definitions and common routines useful in parsing and dumping
the contents of RTAS events.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libselinux-1.33.4-4.el5 - libselinux-1.33.4-5.1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: SELinux library and simple utilities

Description:

Security-enhanced Linux is a feature of the Linux® kernel and a


number
of utilities with enhanced security functionality designed to add
mandatory access controls to Linux. The Security-enhanced Linux
kernel contains new architectural components originally developed
to
improve the security of the Flask operating system. These
architectural components provide general support for the
enforcement
of many kinds of mandatory access control policies, including
those
based on the concepts of Type Enforcement®, Role-based Access
Control, and Multi-level Security.

libselinux provides an API for SELinux applications to get and set


process and file security contexts and to obtain security policy
decisions. Required for any applications that use the SELinux API.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libtiff-3.8.2-7.el5 - libtiff-3.8.2-7.el5_2.2

Group: System Environment/Libraries

127
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: Library of functions for manipulating TIFF format image files

Description:

The libtiff package contains a library of functions for


manipulating
TIFF (Tagged Image File Format) image format files. TIFF is a
widely
used file format for bitmapped images. TIFF files usually end in
the
.tif extension and they are often quite large.

The libtiff package should be installed if you need to manipulate


TIFF
format image files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libuser-0.54.7-2.el5.2 - libuser-0.54.7-2.el5.5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A user and group account administration library.

Description:

The libuser library implements a standardized interface for


manipulating
and administering user and group accounts. The library uses
pluggable
back-ends to interface to its data sources.

Sample applications modeled after those included with the shadow


password
suite are included.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libutempter-1.1.4-3.fc6 - libutempter-1.1.4-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A privileged helper for utmp/wtmp updates

Description:

This library provides interface for terminal emulators such as


screen and xterm to record user sessions to utmp and wtmp files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

128
12. Updated Packages

libvirt-0.2.3-9.el5 - libvirt-0.3.3-14.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Library providing a simple API virtualization

Description:

Libvirt is a C toolkit to interract with the virtualization


capabilities
of recent versions of Linux (and other OSes).

Added Dependencies:

avahi-devel

bridge-utils

dnsmasq

gnutls-devel

Removed Dependencies:

/sbin/iptables

libsysfs-devel

libvorbis-1.1.2-3.el5.0 - libvorbis-1.1.2-3.el5_1.2

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The Vorbis General Audio Compression Codec.

Description:

Ogg Vorbis is a fully open, non-proprietary, patent-and royalty-


free,
general-purpose compressed audio format for audio and music at
fixed
and variable bitrates from 16 to 128 kbps/channel.

The libvorbis package contains runtime libraries for use in


programs
that support Ogg Voribs.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libxml2-2.6.26-2.1.2 - libxml2-2.6.26-2.1.2.7

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Library providing XML and HTML support

Description:

This library allows to manipulate XML files. It includes support

129
5.3 Release Notes

to read, modify and write XML and HTML files. There is DTDs
support
this includes parsing and validation even with complex DtDs,
either
at parse time or later once the document has been modified. The
output
can be a simple SAX stream or and in-memory DOM like
representations.
In this case one can use the built-in XPath and XPointer
implementation
to select subnodes or ranges. A flexible Input/Output mechanism is
available, with existing HTTP and FTP modules and combined to an
URI library.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

libxslt-1.1.17-2 - libxslt-1.1.17-2.el5_2.2

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Library providing the Gnome XSLT engine

Description:

This C library allows to transform XML files into other XML files
(or HTML, text, ...) using the standard XSLT stylesheet
transformation
mechanism. To use it you need to have a version of libxml2 >=
2.6.25
installed. The xsltproc command is a command line interface to the
XSLT engine

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

linuxwacom-0.7.4.3-2.el5 - linuxwacom-0.7.8.3-5.el5

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Wacom Drivers from Linux Wacom Project

Description:

The Linux Wacom Project manages the drivers, libraries, and


documentation for configuring and running Wacom tablets under the
Linux operating system. It contains diagnostic applications as
well as
X.org XInput drivers.

Added Dependencies:

desktop-file-utils

tcl-devel

130
12. Updated Packages

tk-devel

No removed dependencies

lm_sensors-2.10.0-3.1 - lm_sensors-2.10.7-4.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Hardware monitoring tools.

Description:

The lm_sensors package includes a collection of modules for


general SMBus
access and hardware monitoring. NOTE: this requires special
support which
is not in standard 2.2-vintage kernels.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

logrotate-3.7.4-7 - logrotate-3.7.4-9

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Rotates, compresses, removes and mails system log files.

Description:

The logrotate utility is designed to simplify the administration


of
log files on a system which generates a lot of log files.
Logrotate
allows for the automatic rotation compression, removal and mailing
of
log files. Logrotate can be set to handle a log file daily,
weekly,
monthly or when the log file gets to a certain size. Normally,
logrotate runs as a daily cron job.

Install the logrotate package if you need a utility to deal with


the
log files on your system.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

logwatch-7.3-5 - logwatch-7.3-6.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A log file analysis program

Description:

Logwatch is a customizable, pluggable log-monitoring system. It

131
5.3 Release Notes

will go
through your logs for a given period of time and make a report in
the areas
that you wish with the detail that you wish. Easy to use - works
right out
of the package on many systems.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ltrace-0.5-6.45svn.fc6 - ltrace-0.5-7.45svn.el5

Group: Development/Debuggers

Summary: Tracks runtime library calls from dynamically linked


executables.

Description:

Ltrace is a debugging program which runs a specified command until


the
command exits. While the command is executing, ltrace intercepts
and
records both the dynamic library calls called by the executed
process
and the signals received by the executed process. Ltrace can also
intercept and print system calls executed by the process.

You should install ltrace if you need a sysadmin tool for tracking
the
execution of processes.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

lvm2-2.02.26-3.el5 - lvm2-2.02.40-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Userland logical volume management tools

Description:

LVM2 includes all of the support for handling read/write


operations on
physical volumes (hard disks, RAID-Systems, magneto optical, etc.,
multiple devices (MD), see mdadd(8) or even loop devices, see
losetup(8)), creating volume groups (kind of virtual disks) from
one
or more physical volumes and creating one or more logical volumes
(kind of logical partitions) in volume groups.

Added Dependencies:

device-mapper >= 1.02.28-2

132
12. Updated Packages

Removed Dependencies:

device-mapper >= 1.02.20-1

lvm2-cluster-2.02.26-1.el5 - lvm2-cluster-2.02.40-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Cluster extensions for userland logical volume management


tools

Description:

Extensions to LVM2 to support clusters.

Added Dependencies:

device-mapper >= 1.02.28-2

Removed Dependencies:

device-mapper >= 1.02.20-1

lynx-2.8.5-28.1 - lynx-2.8.5-28.1.el5_2.1

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: A text-based Web browser.

Description:

Lynx is a text-based Web browser. Lynx does not display any


images,
but it does support frames, tables, and most other HTML tags. One
advantage Lynx has over graphical browsers is speed; Lynx starts
and
exits quickly and swiftly displays webpages.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

m17n-db-1.3.3-46.el5 - m17n-db-1.3.3-48.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Multilingualization datafiles for m17n-lib

Description:

This package contains multilingualization (m17n) datafiles for


m17n-lib
which describe input maps, encoding maps, and OpenType font data
for many languages.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

133
5.3 Release Notes

m2crypto-0.16-6.el5.1 - m2crypto-0.16-6.el5.3

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Support for using OpenSSL in python scripts

Description:

This package allows you to call OpenSSL functions from python


scripts.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mailman-2.1.9-2 - mailman-2.1.9-4.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Mailing list manager with built in Web access.

Description:

Mailman is software to help manage email discussion lists, much


like
Majordomo and Smartmail. Unlike most similar products, Mailman
gives
each mailing list a webpage, and allows users to subscribe,
unsubscribe, etc. over the Web. Even the list manager can
administer
his or her list entirely from the Web. Mailman also integrates
most
things people want to do with mailing lists, including archiving,
mail
<-> news gateways, and so on.

Documentation can be found in: /usr/share/doc/mailman-2.1.9

When the package has finished installing, you will need to perform
some
additional installation steps, these are described in:
/usr/share/doc/mailman-2.1.9/INSTALL.REDHAT

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

make-3.81-1.1 - make-3.81-3.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: A GNU tool which simplifies the build process for users.

Description:

A GNU tool for controlling the generation of executables and other


non-source files of a program from the program's source files.
Make

134
12. Updated Packages

allows users to build and install packages without any significant


knowledge about the details of the build process. The details
about
how the program should be built are provided for make in the
program's
makefile.

The GNU make tool should be installed on your system because it is


commonly used to simplify the process of installing programs.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

man-pages-2.39-10.el5 - man-pages-2.39-12.el5

Group: Documentation

Summary: Man (manual) pages from the Linux Documentation Project.

Description:

A large collection of man pages (documentation) from the Linux


Documentation Project (LDP).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

man-pages-ja-20060815-5 - man-pages-ja-20060815-9.el5

Group: Documentation

Summary: Japanese man (manual) pages from the Japanese Manual Project

Description:

Japanese Manual pages, translated by JM-Project (Japanese Manual


Project).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mcstrans-0.2.6-1.el5 - mcstrans-0.2.11-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: SELinux Translation Daemon

Description:

Security-enhanced Linux is a feature of the Linux® kernel and a


number
of utilities with enhanced security functionality designed to add
mandatory access controls to Linux. The Security-enhanced Linux
kernel contains new architectural components originally developed
to

135
5.3 Release Notes

improve the security of the Flask operating system. These


architectural components provide general support for the
enforcement
of many kinds of mandatory access control policies, including
those
based on the concepts of Type Enforcement®, Role-based Access
Control, and Multi-level Security.

mcstrans provides an translation daemon to translate SELinux


categories
from internal representations to user defined representation.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mdadm-2.5.4-3.el5 - mdadm-2.6.4-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: mdadm controls Linux md devices (software RAID arrays)

Description:

mdadm is used to create, manage, and monitor Linux MD (software


RAID)
devices. As such, it provides similar functionality to the
raidtools
package. However, mdadm is a single program, and it can perform
almost all functions without a configuration file, though a
configuration
file can be used to help with some common tasks.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mesa-6.5.1-7.5.el5 - mesa-6.5.1-7.7.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Mesa graphics libraries

Description:

Mesa

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

metacity-2.16.0-8.el5 - metacity-2.16.0-12.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: Metacity window manager

Description:

136
12. Updated Packages

Metacity is a simple window manager that integrates nicely with


GNOME 2.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

microcode_ctl-1.17-1.42.el5 - microcode_ctl-1.17-1.47.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tool to update x86/x86-64 CPU microcode.

Description:

microcode_ctl - updates the microcode on Intel x86/x86-64 CPU's

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mkinitrd-5.1.19.6-19 - mkinitrd-5.1.19.6-44

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Creates an initial ramdisk image for preloading modules.

Description:

Mkinitrd creates filesystem images for use as initial ramdisk


(initrd)
images. These ramdisk images are often used to preload the block
device modules (SCSI or RAID) needed to access the root
filesystem.

In other words, generic kernels can be built without drivers for


any
SCSI adapters which load the SCSI driver as a module. Since the
kernel needs to read those modules, but in this case it isn't able
to
address the SCSI adapter, an initial ramdisk is used. The initial
ramdisk is loaded by the operating system loader (normally LILO)
and
is available to the kernel as soon as the ramdisk is loaded. The
ramdisk image loads the proper SCSI adapter and allows the kernel
to
mount the root filesystem. The mkinitrd program creates such a
ramdisk using information found in the /etc/modules.conf file.

Added Dependencies:

libdhcp-devel >= 1.20-6

Removed Dependencies:

libdhcp-devel >= 1.9

137
5.3 Release Notes

mlocate-0.15-1.el5 - mlocate-0.15-1.el5.1

Group: Applications/System

Summary: An utility for finding files by name

Description:

mlocate is a locate/updatedb implementation. It keeps a database


of
all existing files and allows you to lookup files by name.

The 'm' stands for "merging": updatedb reuses the existing database
to avoid
rereading most of the file system, which makes updatedb faster and
does not
trash the system caches as much as traditional locate
implementations.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mod_nss-1.0.3-4.el5 - mod_nss-1.0.3-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: SSL/TLS module for the Apache HTTP server

Description:

The mod_nss module provides strong cryptography for the Apache Web
server via the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) and Transport Layer
Security (TLS) protocols using the Network Security Services (NSS)
security library.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mod_perl-2.0.2-6.3.el5 - mod_perl-2.0.4-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: An embedded Perl interpreter for the Apache HTTP Server

Description:

Mod_perl incorporates a Perl interpreter into the Apache web


server,
so that the Apache web server can directly execute Perl code.
Mod_perl links the Perl runtime library into the Apache web server
and
provides an object-oriented Perl interface for Apache's C language
API. The end result is a quicker CGI script turnaround process,
since
no external Perl interpreter has to be started.

138
12. Updated Packages

Install mod_perl if you're installing the Apache web server and


you'd
like for it to directly incorporate a Perl interpreter.

Added Dependencies:

perl

perl(ExtUtils::Embed)

Removed Dependencies:

perl >= 1:5.6.1

module-init-tools-3.3-0.pre3.1.34.el5 - module-init-tools-3.3-0.pre3.1.42.el5

Group: System Environment/Kernel

Summary: Kernel module management utilities.

Description:

The modutils package includes various programs needed for


automatic
loading and unloading of modules under 2.6 and later kernels, as
well
as other module management programs. Device drivers and
filesystems
are two examples of loaded and unloaded modules.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mozldap-6.0.4-1.el5 - mozldap-6.0.5-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Mozilla LDAP C SDK

Description:

The Mozilla LDAP C SDK is a set of libraries that


allow applications to communicate with LDAP directory
servers. These libraries are derived from the University
of Michigan and Netscape LDAP libraries. They use Mozilla
NSPR and NSS for crypto.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

mysql-5.0.22-2.1.0.1 - mysql-5.0.45-7.el5

Group: Applications/Databases

Summary: MySQL client programs and shared libraries.

Description:

139
5.3 Release Notes

MySQL is a multi-user, multi-threaded SQL database server. MySQL


is a
client/server implementation consisting of a server daemon
(mysqld)
and many different client programs and libraries. The base package
contains the MySQL client programs, the client shared libraries,
and
generic MySQL files.

Added Dependencies:

gawk

No removed dependencies

nautilus-2.16.2-6.el5 - nautilus-2.16.2-7.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: Nautilus is a file manager for GNOME.

Description:

Nautilus integrates access to files, applications, media,


Internet-based resources and the Web. Nautilus delivers a dynamic
and
rich user experience. Nautilus is an free software project
developed
under the GNU General Public License and is a core component of
the
GNOME desktop project.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

neon-0.25.5-5.1 - neon-0.25.5-10.el5

Group: Applications/Publishing

Summary: An HTTP and WebDAV client library

Description:

neon is an HTTP and WebDAV client library, with a C interface;


providing a high-level interface to HTTP and WebDAV methods along
with a low-level interface for HTTP request handling. neon
supports persistent connections, proxy servers, basic, digest and
Kerberos authentication, and has complete SSL support.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

net-snmp-5.3.1-19.el5 - net-snmp-5.3.2.2-5.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

140
12. Updated Packages

Summary: A collection of SNMP protocol tools and libraries.

Description:

SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) is a protocol used for


network management. The NET-SNMP project includes various SNMP
tools:
an extensible agent, an SNMP library, tools for requesting or
setting
information from SNMP agents, tools for generating and handling
SNMP
traps, a version of the netstat command which uses SNMP, and a
Tk/Perl
mib browser. This package contains the snmpd and snmptrapd
daemons,
documentation, etc.

You will probably also want to install the net-snmp-utils package,


which contains NET-SNMP utilities.

Building option:
--without tcp_wrappers : disable tcp_wrappers support

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

net-tools-1.60-73 - net-tools-1.60-78.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Basic networking tools.

Description:

The net-tools package contains basic networking tools, including


ifconfig, netstat, route, and others.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

newt-0.52.2-9 - newt-0.52.2-12.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A development library for text mode user interfaces.

Description:

Newt is a programming library for color text mode, widget based


user
interfaces. Newt can be used to add stacked windows, entry
widgets,
checkboxes, radio buttons, labels, plain text fields, scrollbars,

141
5.3 Release Notes

etc., to text mode user interfaces. This package also contains the
shared library needed by programs built with newt, as well as a
/usr/bin/dialog replacement called whiptail. Newt is based on the
slang library.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

nfs-utils-1.0.9-24.el5 - nfs-utils-1.0.9-40.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: NFS utilities and supporting clients and daemons for the
kernel NFS server.

Description:

The nfs-utils package provides a daemon for the kernel NFS server
and
related tools, which provides a much higher level of performance
than the
traditional Linux NFS server used by most users.

This package also contains the showmount program. Showmount


queries the
mount daemon on a remote host for information about the NFS
(Network File
System) server on the remote host. For example, showmount can
display the
clients which are mounted on that host.

This package also contains the mount.nfs and umount.nfs program.

Added Dependencies:

tcp_wrappers

No removed dependencies

notification-daemon-0.3.5-8.el5 - notification-daemon-0.3.5-9.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Notification Daemon

Description:

notification-daemon is the server implementation of the


freedesktop.org desktop
notification specification.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

nspr-4.6.5-3.el5 - nspr-4.7.3-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

142
12. Updated Packages

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Netscape Portable Runtime

Description:

NSPR provides platform independence for non-GUI operating system


facilities. These facilities include threads, thread
synchronization,
normal file and network I/O, interval timing and calendar time,
basic
memory management (malloc and free) and shared library linking.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

nss-3.11.7-1.3.el5 - nss-3.12.2.0-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Network Security Services

Description:

Network Security Services (NSS) is a set of libraries designed to


support cross-platform development of security-enabled client and
server applications. Applications built with NSS can support SSL
v2
and v3, TLS, PKCS #5, PKCS #7, PKCS #11, PKCS #12, S/MIME, X.509
v3 certificates, and other security standards.

Added Dependencies:

nspr-devel >= 4.6.99

zlib-devel

Removed Dependencies:

nspr-devel >= 4.6.2

nss_db-2.2-35.1 - nss_db-2.2-35.3

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: An NSS library for the Berkeley DB.

Description:

Nss_db is a set of C library extensions which allow Berkeley


Databases
to be used as a primary source of aliases, ethers, groups, hosts,
networks, protocol, users, RPCs, services, and shadow passwords
(instead of or in addition to using flat files or NIS). Install
nss_db
if your flat name service files are too large and lookups are
slow.

143
5.3 Release Notes

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

nss_ldap-253-5.el5 - nss_ldap-253-17.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: NSS library and PAM module for LDAP.

Description:

This package includes two LDAP access clients: nss_ldap and


pam_ldap.
Nss_ldap is a set of C library extensions that allow X.500 and
LDAP
directory servers to be used as a primary source of aliases,
ethers,
groups, hosts, networks, protocol, users, RPCs, services, and
shadow
passwords (instead of or in addition to using flat files or NIS).

Pam_ldap is a module for Linux-PAM that supports password changes,


V2
clients, Netscape's SSL, ypldapd, Netscape Directory Server
password
policies, access authorization, and crypted hashes.

Added Dependencies:

fipscheck-devel

keyutils-libs-devel

libselinux-devel

No removed dependencies

ntp-4.2.2p1-7.el5 - ntp-4.2.2p1-9.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Synchronizes system time using the Network Time Protocol


(NTP).

Description:

The Network Time Protocol (NTP) is used to synchronize a


computer's
time with another reference time source. The ntp package contains
utilities and daemons that will synchronize your computer's time
to
Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) via the NTP protocol and NTP
servers.
The ntp package includes ntpdate (a program for retrieving the
date
and time from remote machines via a network) and ntpd (a daemon
which

144
12. Updated Packages

continuously adjusts system time).

Install the ntp package if you need tools for keeping your
system's
time synchronized via the NTP protocol.

Added Dependencies:

perl-HTML-Parser

No removed dependencies

numactl-0.9.8-2.el5 - numactl-0.9.8-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: library for tuning for Non Uniform Memory Access machines

Description:

Simple NUMA policy support. It consists of a numactl program to


run
other programs with a specific NUMA policy and a libnuma to do
allocations with NUMA policy in applications.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

oddjob-0.27-7 - oddjob-0.27-9.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: A D-BUS service which runs odd jobs on behalf of client


applications

Description:

oddjob is a D-BUS service which performs particular tasks for


clients which
connect to it and issue requests using the system-wide message
bus.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

openCryptoki-2.2.4-16.el5 - openCryptoki-2.2.4-22.el5

Group: Productivity/Security

Summary: Implementation of Cryptoki v2.11 for IBM Crypto Hardware

Description:

145
5.3 Release Notes

The PKCS#11 Version 2.11 api implemented for the IBM Crypto cards.
This package includes support for the IBM 4758 Cryptographic
CoProcessor (with the PKCS#11 firmware loaded) and the IBM eServer
Cryptographic Accelerator (FC 4960 on pSeries)

Added Dependencies:

trousers-devel

No removed dependencies

openais-0.80.3-7.el5 - openais-0.80.3-22.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The openais Standards-Based Cluster Framework executive and


APIs

Description:

This package contains the openais executive, openais service


handlers,
default configuration files and init script.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

openhpi-2.8.1-2.el5.7 - openhpi-2.10.2-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: openhpi Hardware Platform Interface (HPI) library and tools

Description:

OpenHPI is an open source project created with the intent of


providing an
implementation of the SA Forum's Hardware Platform Interface
(HPI). HPI
provides an abstracted interface to managing computer hardware,
typically for
chassis and rack based servers. HPI includes resource modeling;
access to and
control over sensor, control, watchdog, and inventory data
associated with
resources; abstracted System Event Log interfaces; hardware events
and alerts;
and a managed hotswap interface.

OpenHPI provides a modular mechanism for adding new hardware and


device support
easily. Many plugins exist in the OpenHPI source tree to provide
access to
various types of hardware. This includes, but is not limited to,
IPMI based
servers, Blade Center, and machines which export data via sysfs.

146
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

openib-1.2-6.el5 - openib-1.3.2-0.20080728.0355.3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: OpenIB Infiniband Driver Stack

Description:

User space initialization scripts for the kernel InfiniBand


drivers

No added dependencies

Removed Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

libsysfs-devel

libtool

pciutils-devel

zlib-devel

openldap-2.3.27-8 - openldap-2.3.43-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The configuration files, libraries, and documentation for


OpenLDAP.

Description:

OpenLDAP is an open source suite of LDAP (Lightweight Directory


Access
Protocol) applications and development tools. LDAP is a set of
protocols for accessing directory services (usually phone book
style
information, but other information is possible) over the Internet,
similar to the way DNS (Domain Name System) information is
propagated
over the Internet. The openldap package contains configuration
files,
libraries, and documentation for OpenLDAP.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

openmotif-2.3.0-0.3.el5 - openmotif-2.3.1-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

147
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: Open Motif runtime libraries and executables.

Description:

This is the Open Motif 2.3.1 runtime environment. It includes the


Motif shared libraries, needed to run applications which are
dynamically
linked against Motif, and the Motif Window Manager "mwm".

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

openmpi-1.2.3-4.el5 - openmpi-1.2.7-6.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Open Message Passing Interface

Description:

Open MPI is an open source, freely available implementation of


both the
MPI-1 and MPI-2 standards, combining technologies and resources
from
several other projects (FT-MPI, LA-MPI, LAM/MPI, and PACX-MPI) in
order to build the best MPI library available. A completely new
MPI-2
compliant implementation, Open MPI offers advantages for system
and
software vendors, application developers, and computer science
researchers. For more information, see http://www.open-mpi.org/ .

Added Dependencies:

compat-dapl-devel

Removed Dependencies:

dapl-devel

libsysfs-devel

openssh-4.3p2-24.el5 - openssh-4.3p2-29.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: The OpenSSH implementation of SSH protocol versions 1 and 2

Description:

SSH (Secure SHell) is a program for logging into and executing


commands on a remote machine. SSH is intended to replace rlogin
and
rsh, and to provide secure encrypted communications between two
untrusted hosts over an insecure network. X11 connections and
arbitrary TCP/IP ports can also be forwarded over the secure
channel.

148
12. Updated Packages

OpenSSH is OpenBSD's version of the last free version of SSH,


bringing
it up to date in terms of security and features, as well as
removing
all patented algorithms to separate libraries.

This package includes the core files necessary for both the
OpenSSH
client and server. To make this package useful, you should also
install openssh-clients, openssh-server, or both.

Added Dependencies:

openssl-devel >= 0.9.8e

Removed Dependencies:

openssl-devel

openssl-0.9.8b-8.3.el5_0.2 - openssl-0.9.8e-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The OpenSSL toolkit

Description:

The OpenSSL toolkit provides support for secure communications


between
machines. OpenSSL includes a certificate management tool and
shared
libraries which provide various cryptographic algorithms and
protocols.

Added Dependencies:

fipscheck

No removed dependencies

openssl097a-0.9.7a-9 - openssl097a-0.9.7a-9.el5_2.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: The OpenSSL toolkit

Description:

The OpenSSL toolkit provides support for secure communications


between
machines. OpenSSL includes a certificate management tool and
shared
libraries which provide various cryptographic algorithms and
protocols.

No added dependencies

149
5.3 Release Notes

No removed dependencies

oprofile-0.9.2-6.el5 - oprofile-0.9.3-18.el5

Group: Development/System

Summary: System wide profiler

Description:

OProfile is a profiling system for systems running Linux. The


profiling runs transparently during the background, and profile
data
can be collected at any time. OProfile makes use of the hardware
performance
counters provided on Intel P6, and AMD Athlon family processors,
and can use
the RTC for profiling on other x86 processor types.

See the HTML documentation for further details.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pam-0.99.6.2-3.26.el5 - pam-0.99.6.2-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A security tool which provides authentication for


applications

Description:

PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) is a system security tool


that
allows system administrators to set authentication policy without
having to recompile programs that handle authentication.

Added Dependencies:

audit-libs-devel >= 1.6.5

kernel-headers >= 2.6.18-114

Removed Dependencies:

audit-libs-devel >= 1.0.8

pam_krb5-2.2.14-1 - pam_krb5-2.2.14-10

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A Pluggable Authentication Module for Kerberos 5.

Description:

This is pam_krb5, a pluggable authentication module that can be

150
12. Updated Packages

used with
Linux-PAM and Kerberos 5. This module supports password checking,
ticket
creation, and optional TGT verification and conversion to Kerberos
IV tickets.
The included pam_krb5afs module also gets AFS tokens if so
configured.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

libtool

No removed dependencies

paps-0.6.6-17.el5 - paps-0.6.6-18.el5

Group: Applications/Publishing

Summary: Plain Text to PostScript converter

Description:

paps is a PostScript converter from plain text file using Pango.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

parted-1.8.1-12.el5 - parted-1.8.1-23.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: The GNU disk partition manipulation program

Description:

The GNU Parted program allows you to create, destroy, resize,


move,
and copy hard disk partitions. Parted can be used for creating
space
for new operating systems, reorganizing disk usage, and copying
data
to new hard disks.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

patch-2.5.4-29.2.2 - patch-2.5.4-29.2.3.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: The GNU patch command, for modifying/upgrading files.

Description:

151
5.3 Release Notes

The patch program applies diff files to originals. The diff


command
is used to compare an original to a changed file. Diff lists the
changes made to the file. A person who has the original file can
then
use the patch command with the diff file to add the changes to
their
original file (patching the file).

Patch should be installed because it is a common way of upgrading


applications.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pciutils-2.2.3-4 - pciutils-2.2.3-5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: PCI bus related utilities.

Description:

The pciutils package contains various utilities for inspecting and


setting devices connected to the PCI bus. The utilities provided
require kernel version 2.1.82 or newer (which support the
/proc/bus/pci interface).

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pcre-6.6-1.1 - pcre-6.6-2.el5_1.7

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Perl-compatible regular expression library

Description:

Perl-compatible regular expression library.


PCRE has its own native API, but a set of "wrapper" functions that
are based on
the POSIX API are also supplied in the library libpcreposix. Note
that this
just provides a POSIX calling interface to PCRE: the regular
expressions
themselves still follow Perl syntax and semantics. The header file
for the POSIX-style functions is called pcreposix.h.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pcsc-lite-1.3.1-7 - pcsc-lite-1.4.4-0.1.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

152
12. Updated Packages

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: PC/SC Lite smart card framework and applications

Description:

The purpose of PC/SC Lite is to provide a Windows(R) SCard


interface
in a very small form factor for communicating to smartcards and
readers. PC/SC Lite uses the same winscard API as used under
Windows(R). This package includes the PC/SC Lite daemon, a
resource
manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers
and
smart cards that are connected to the system, as well as other
command
line tools.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

perl-5.8.8-10 - perl-5.8.8-18.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: The Perl programming language

Description:

Perl is a high-level programming language with roots in C, sed,


awk
and shell scripting. Perl is good at handling processes and files,
and is especially good at handling text. Perl's hallmarks are
practicality and efficiency. While it is used to do a lot of
different things, Perl's most common applications are system
administration utilities and web programming. A large proportion
of
the CGI scripts on the web are written in Perl. You need the perl
package installed on your system so that your system can handle
Perl
scripts.

Install this package if you want to program in Perl or enable your


system to handle Perl scripts.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

perl-DBD-MySQL-3.0007-1.fc6 - perl-DBD-MySQL-3.0007-2.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A MySQL interface for perl

Description:

153
5.3 Release Notes

An implementation of DBI for MySQL for Perl.

Added Dependencies:

perl-DBI >= 1.52-2

Removed Dependencies:

perl(DBI)

perl-DBD-Pg-1.49-1.fc6 - perl-DBD-Pg-1.49-2.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A PostgresSQL interface for perl

Description:

An implementation of DBI for PostgreSQL for Perl.

Added Dependencies:

perl-DBI >= 1.52-2

Removed Dependencies:

perl-DBI >= 1.38

perl-DBI-1.52-1.fc6 - perl-DBI-1.52-2.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A database access API for perl

Description:

DBI is a database access Application Programming Interface (API)


for
the Perl Language. The DBI API Specification defines a set of
functions, variables and conventions that provide a consistent
database interface independent of the actual database being used.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pfmon-3.2-0.060926.4.el5 - pfmon-3.2-0.060926.5.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: a performance monitoring tool for Linux/ia64

Description:

This package contains pfmon 3.x, a tool to monitor performance


using
the Performance Monitor Unit (PMU). Pfmon can monitor
standalone programs or the entire system on both UP and SMP Linux

154
12. Updated Packages

systems.
This version
of pfmon requires a kernel perfmon-2.x (found in 2.6 kernels)
subsystem to
function properly.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

php-5.1.6-15.el5 - php-5.1.6-23.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: The PHP HTML-embedded scripting language. (PHP: Hypertext


Preprocessor)

Description:

PHP is an HTML-embedded scripting language. PHP attempts to make


it
easy for developers to write dynamically generated webpages. PHP
also
offers built-in database integration for several commercial and
non-commercial database management systems, so writing a
database-enabled webpage with PHP is fairly simple. The most
common
use of PHP coding is probably as a replacement for CGI scripts.

The php package contains the module which adds support for the PHP
language to Apache HTTP Server.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

php-pear-1.4.9-4 - php-pear-1.4.9-4.el5.1

Group: System

Summary: PHP Extension and Application Repository framework

Description:

PEAR is a framework and distribution system for reusable PHP


components. This package contains the basic PEAR components.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

piranha-0.8.4-7.el5 - piranha-0.8.4-11.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Cluster administation tools

Description:

155
5.3 Release Notes

Various tools to administer and configure the Linux Virtual Server


as well as
heartbeating and failover components. The LVS is a dynamically
adjusted
kernel routing mechanism that provides load balancing primarily
for web
and ftp servers though other services are supported.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pirut-1.2.10-1.el5 - pirut-1.3.28-13.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Package Installation, Removal and Update Tools

Description:

pirut (pronounced "pirate") provides a set of graphical tools for


managing
software.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pkgconfig-0.21-1.fc6 - pkgconfig-0.21-2.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: A tool for determining compilation options.

Description:

The pkgconfig tool determines compilation options. For each


required
library, it reads the configuration file and outputs the necessary
compiler and linker flags.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pkinit-nss-0.7.3-1.el5 - pkinit-nss-0.7.6-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: PKINIT for MIT Kerberos

Description:

The pkinit-nss package implements the PKINIT standard for MIT


Kerberos. It
does so using the Mozilla NSS library.

156
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pm-utils-0.99.3-6.el5.17 - pm-utils-0.99.3-10.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Power management utilities and scripts for Fedora Core

Description:

The pm-utils package contains utilities and scripts for Fedora


Core
useful for power management.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

policycoreutils-1.33.12-12.el5 - policycoreutils-1.33.12-14.2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: SELinux policy core utilities.

Description:

Security-enhanced Linux is a feature of the Linux® kernel and a


number
of utilities with enhanced security functionality designed to add
mandatory access controls to Linux. The Security-enhanced Linux
kernel contains new architectural components originally developed
to
improve the security of the Flask operating system. These
architectural components provide general support for the
enforcement
of many kinds of mandatory access control policies, including
those
based on the concepts of Type Enforcement®, Role-based Access
Control, and Multi-level Security.

policycoreutils contains the policy core utilities that are


required
for basic operation of a SELinux system. These utilities include
load_policy to load policies, setfiles to label filesystems,
newrole
to switch roles, and run_init to run /etc/init.d scripts in the
proper
context.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

poppler-0.5.4-4.1.el5 - poppler-0.5.4-4.4.el5_1

Group: Development/Libraries

157
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: PDF rendering library

Description:

Poppler, a PDF rendering library, it's a fork of the xpdf PDF


viewer developed by Derek Noonburg of Glyph and Cog, LLC.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

postfix-2.3.3-2 - postfix-2.3.3-2.1.el5_2

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Postfix Mail Transport Agent

Description:

Postfix is a Mail Transport Agent (MTA), supporting LDAP, SMTP


AUTH (SASL),
TLS

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

postgresql-8.1.9-1.el5 - postgresql-8.1.11-1.el5_1.1

Group: Applications/Databases

Summary: PostgreSQL client programs and libraries.

Description:

PostgreSQL is an advanced Object-Relational database management


system
(DBMS) that supports almost all SQL constructs (including
transactions, subselects and user-defined types and functions).
The
postgresql package includes the client programs and libraries that
you'll need to access a PostgreSQL DBMS server. These PostgreSQL
client programs are programs that directly manipulate the internal
structure of PostgreSQL databases on a PostgreSQL server. These
client
programs can be located on the same machine with the PostgreSQL
server, or may be on a remote machine which accesses a PostgreSQL
server over a network connection. This package contains the docs
in HTML for the whole package, as well as command-line utilities
for
managing PostgreSQL databases on a PostgreSQL server.

If you want to manipulate a PostgreSQL database on a remote


PostgreSQL
server, you need this package. You also need to install this
package
if you're installing the postgresql-server package.

158
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ppc64-utils-0.11-2 - ppc64-utils-0.11-10.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Linux/PPC64 specific utilities

Description:

A collection of utilities for Linux on PPC64 platforms.

Added Dependencies:

db4-devel

librtas-devel >= 1.3.3

libstdc++-devel

libtool

sg3_utils-devel

zlib-devel

Removed Dependencies:

librtas-devel

ppp-2.4.4-1.el5 - ppp-2.4.4-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The PPP (Point-to-Point Protocol) daemon.

Description:

The ppp package contains the PPP (Point-to-Point Protocol) daemon


and
documentation for PPP support. The PPP protocol provides a method
for
transmitting datagrams over serial point-to-point links. PPP is
usually used to dial in to an ISP (Internet Service Provider) or
other
organization over a modem and phone line.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

prelink-0.3.9-2.1 - prelink-0.4.0-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: An ELF prelinking utility

Description:

159
5.3 Release Notes

The prelink package contains a utility which modifies ELF shared


libraries
and executables, so that far fewer relocations need to be resolved
at runtime
and thus programs come up faster.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

privoxy-3.0.3-9.2.2 - privoxy-3.0.3-9.3.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: Privoxy - privacy enhancing proxy

Description:

Privoxy is a web proxy with advanced filtering capabilities for


protecting privacy, filtering web page content, managing cookies,
controlling access, and removing ads, banners, pop-ups and other
obnoxious Internet junk. Privoxy has a very flexible configuration
and
can be customized to suit individual needs and tastes. Privoxy has
application
for both stand-alone systems and multi-user networks.

Privoxy is based on the Internet Junkbuster.

Added Dependencies:

pcre-devel

No removed dependencies

procps-3.2.7-8.1.el5 - procps-3.2.7-11.1.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: System and process monitoring utilities.

Description:

The procps package contains a set of system utilities that provide


system information. Procps includes ps, free, skill, pkill, pgrep,
snice, tload, top, uptime, vmstat, w, watch and pdwx. The ps
command
displays a snapshot of running processes. The top command provides
a repetitive update of the statuses of running processes. The free
command displays the amounts of free and used memory on your
system. The skill command sends a terminate command (or another
specified signal) to a specified set of processes. The snice
command is used to change the scheduling priority of specified
processes. The tload command prints a graph of the current system
load average to a specified tty. The uptime command displays the
current time, how long the system has been running, how many users
are logged on, and system load averages for the past one, five,

160
12. Updated Packages

and fifteen minutes. The w command displays a list of the users


who are currently logged on and what they are running. The watch
program watches a running program. The vmstat command displays
virtual memory statistics about processes, memory, paging, block
I/O, traps, and CPU activity. The pwdx command reports the current
working directory of a process or processes.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

psacct-6.3.2-41.1 - psacct-6.3.2-44.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Utilities for monitoring process activities.

Description:

The psacct package contains several utilities for monitoring


process
activities, including ac, lastcomm, accton and sa. The ac command
displays statistics about how long users have been logged on. The
lastcomm command displays information about previous executed
commands. The accton command turns process accounting on or off.
The
sa command summarizes information about previously executed
commands.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

psmisc-22.2-5 - psmisc-22.2-6

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Utilities for managing processes on your system.

Description:

The psmisc package contains utilities for managing processes on


your
system: pstree, killall and fuser. The pstree command displays a
tree
structure of all of the running processes on your system. The
killall
command sends a specified signal (SIGTERM if nothing is specified)
to
processes identified by name. The fuser command identifies the
PIDs
of processes that are using specified files or filesystems.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pygtk2-2.10.1-8.el5 - pygtk2-2.10.1-12.el5

161
5.3 Release Notes

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: Python bindings for the GTK+ widget set.

Description:

PyGTK is an extension module for python that gives you access to


the GTK+
widget set. Just about anything you can write in C with GTK+ you
can write
in python with PyGTK (within reason), but with all the benefits of
python.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

pykickstart-0.43-1.el5 - pykickstart-0.43.3-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A python library for manipulating kickstart files

Description:

The pykickstart package is a python library for manipulating


kickstart
files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

python-2.4.3-19.el5 - python-2.4.3-24.el5

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: An interpreted, interactive, object-oriented programming


language.

Description:

Python is an interpreted, interactive, object-oriented programming


language often compared to Tcl, Perl, Scheme or Java. Python
includes
modules, classes, exceptions, very high level dynamic data types
and
dynamic typing. Python supports interfaces to many system calls
and
libraries, as well as to various windowing systems (X11, Motif,
Tk,
Mac and MFC).

Programmers can write new built-in modules for Python in C or C++.


Python can be used as an extension language for applications that
need
a programmable interface. This package contains most of the

162
12. Updated Packages

standard
Python modules, as well as modules for interfacing to the Tix
widget
set for Tk and RPM.

Note that documentation for Python is provided in the python-docs


package.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

python-pyblock-0.26-1.el5 - python-pyblock-0.26-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Python modules for dealing with block devices

Description:

The pyblock contains Python modules for dealing with block


devices.

Added Dependencies:

dmraid-devel >= 1.0.0.rc13-14

Removed Dependencies:

dmraid-devel >= 1.0.0.rc11-FC6.3

python-urlgrabber-3.1.0-2 - python-urlgrabber-3.1.0-5.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A high-level cross-protocol url-grabber

Description:

A high-level cross-protocol url-grabber for python supporting


HTTP, FTP
and file locations. Features include keepalive, byte ranges,
throttling,
authentication, proxies and more.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

python-virtinst-0.103.0-3.el5 - python-virtinst-0.300.2-12.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Python modules for starting Xen guest installations

Description:

virtinst is a module to help in starting installations of

163
5.3 Release Notes

Fedora/Red
Hat Enterprise Linux related distributions inside of virtual
machines. It
supports both paravirt guests (for which only FC and RHEL guests
are
currently supported) as well as fully virtualized guests. It uses
libvirt (http://www.libvirt.org) for starting things.

Also contained is a simple script virt-install which uses


virtinst in a command line mode.

Added Dependencies:

gettext

python

Removed Dependencies:

python-devel

quota-3.13-1.2.3.2.el5 - quota-3.13-1.2.5.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: System administration tools for monitoring users' disk usage.

Description:

The quota package contains system administration tools for


monitoring
and limiting user and or group disk usage per filesystem.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

rdate-1.4-6 - rdate-1.4-8.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Tool for getting the date/time from a remote machine.

Description:

The rdate utility retrieves the date and time from another machine
on
your network, using the protocol described in RFC 868. If you run
rdate as root, it will set your machine's local time to the time
of
the machine that you queried.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

rdesktop-1.4.1-4 - rdesktop-1.4.1-6

Group: User Interface/Desktops

164
12. Updated Packages

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: X client for remote desktop into Windows Terminal Server

Description:

rdesktop is an open source client for Windows NT Terminal Server


and
Windows 2000 & 2003 Terminal Services, capable of natively
speaking
Remote Desktop Protocol (RDP) in order to present the user's NT
desktop. Unlike Citrix ICA, no server extensions are required.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

redhat-menus-6.7.8-2.el5 - redhat-menus-6.7.8-3.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: Configuration and data files for the desktop menus

Description:

This package contains the XML files that describe the menu layout
for
GNOME and KDE, and the .desktop files that define the names and
icons
of "subdirectories" in the menus.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

redhat-release-5Server-5.1.0.2 - redhat-release-5Server-5.3.0.3

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Red Hat Enterprise Linux release file

Description:

Red Hat Enterprise Linux release files

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

redhat-release-notes-5Server-9 - redhat-release-notes-5Server-25

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Red Hat Enterprise Linux release notes files

Description:

Red Hat Enterprise Linux release notes files.

165
5.3 Release Notes

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

redhat-rpm-config-8.0.45-22.el5 - redhat-rpm-config-8.0.45-29.el5

Group: Development/System

Summary: Red Hat specific rpm configuration files.

Description:

Red Hat specific rpm configuration files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

rgmanager-2.0.31-1.el5 - rgmanager-2.0.46-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Open Source HA Resource Group Failover for Red Hat Enterprise
Linux

Description:

Red Hat Resource Group Manager provides high availability of


critical server
applications in the event of planned or unplanned system downtime.

Added Dependencies:

slang-devel

No removed dependencies

rhel-instnum-1.0.7-1.el5 - rhel-instnum-1.0.9-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A library for decoding RHEL installation numbers

Description:

rhel-instnum provides methods for decoding RHEL installation


numbers

No added dependencies

Removed Dependencies:

python

rhn-client-tools-0.4.16-1.el5 - rhn-client-tools-0.4.19-17.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

166
12. Updated Packages

Summary: Support programs and libraries for Red Hat Network

Description:

Red Hat Network Client Tools provides programs and libraries to


allow your
system to receive software updates from Red Hat Network.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

rhnlib-2.2.5-1.el5 - rhnlib-2.2.6-2.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Python libraries for the RHN project

Description:

rhnlib is a collection of python modules used by the


Red Hat Network (http://rhn.redhat.com) software.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

rhpxl-0.41.1-1.el5 - rhpxl-0.41.1-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Python library for configuring and running X.

Description:

The rhpxl (pronounced 'rapunzel') package contains a Python


library for
configuring and running X.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

rpm-4.4.2-47.el5 - rpm-4.4.2.3-9.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The RPM package management system

Description:

The RPM Package Manager (RPM) is a powerful command line driven


package management system capable of installing, uninstalling,
verifying, querying, and updating software packages. Each software
package consists of an archive of files along with information
about
the package like its version, a description, etc.

167
5.3 Release Notes

Added Dependencies:

doxygen

gawk

nss-devel

redhat-rpm-config

Removed Dependencies:

autoconf

beecrypt-devel >= 4.1.2

sed

rsh-0.17-37.el5 - rsh-0.17-38.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Clients for remote access commands (rsh, rlogin, rcp).

Description:

The rsh package contains a set of programs which allow users to


run
commands on remote machines, login to other machines and copy
files
between machines (rsh, rlogin and rcp). All three of these
commands
use rhosts style authentication. This package contains the clients
needed for all of these services.
The rsh package should be installed to enable remote access to
other
machines.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ruby-1.8.5-5.el5 - ruby-1.8.5-5.el5_2.6

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: An interpreter of object-oriented scripting language

Description:

Ruby is the interpreted scripting language for quick and easy


object-oriented programming. It has many features to process text
files and to do system management tasks (as in Perl). It is
simple,
straight-forward, and extensible.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

168
12. Updated Packages

s390utils-1.5.3-10.el5.14 - s390utils-1.5.3-21.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Linux/390 specific utilities.

Description:

This package contains utilities related to Linux for S/390.


The most important programs contained in this package are:

- The cmstools suite to list, check, copy and cat files from a CMS
volume.
- chccwdev, a script to generically change attributes of a ccw
device.
- dasdfmt, which is used to low-level format eckd-dasds with
either the classic linux disk layout or the new z/OS
compatible disk layout.
- dasdview, which displays DASD and VTOC information and dumps the
content
of a DASD to the console.
- fdasd, which is used to create or modify partitions on
eckd-dasds formatted with the z/OS compatible disk layout.
- osasnmpd, a subagent for net-snmp to access the OSA hardware.
- qetharp to query and purge address data in the OSA and
HiperSockets hardware
- qethconf to configure IBM QETH function IPA, VIPA and Proxy ARP.
- src_vipa.sh to start applications using VIPA capabilities
- tunedasd, a tool to adjust tunable parameters on DASD devices
- vmconvert, a tool to convert vm dumps to lkcd compatible dumps.
- vmcp, a tool to send CP commands from a Linux guest to the VM.
- zipl, which is used to make either dasds or tapes bootable
for system IPL or system dump.
- zdump, which is used to retrieve system dumps from either
tapes or dasds.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

sabayon-2.12.4-5.el5 - sabayon-2.12.4-6.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Tool to maintain user profiles in a GNOME desktop

Description:

Sabayon is a tool to help sysadmins and user change and maintain


the
default behaviour of the GNOME desktop. This package contains the
graphical tools which a sysadmin use to manage Sabayon profiles.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

169
5.3 Release Notes

salinfo-1.1-3.el5 - salinfo-1.1-4.el5

Group: Utilities/System

Summary: Sal info tool.

Description:

The IA64 Linux kernel has a Software Abstraction Layer (SAL). One
of
SAL's tasks is to record machine problems such as CMC (correctable
machine checks), CPE (correctable platform errors), MCA (machine
check
architecture) and INIT (cpu initialized after boot). These records
are
provided by SAL to user space. salinfo saves and decodes
CMC/CPE/MCA
and INIT records.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

samba-3.0.25b-0.el5.4 - samba-3.0.33-3.7.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The Samba SMB server.

Description:

Samba is the suite of programs by which a lot of PC-related


machines
share files, printers, and other information (such as lists of
available files and printers). The Windows NT, OS/2, and Linux
operating systems support this natively, and add-on packages can
enable the same thing for DOS, Windows, VMS, UNIX of all kinds,
MVS,
and more. This package provides an SMB server that can be used to
provide network services to SMB (sometimes called "Lan Manager")
clients. Samba uses NetBIOS over TCP/IP (NetBT) protocols and does
NOT
need the NetBEUI (Microsoft Raw NetBIOS frame) protocol.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

sblim-1-29.EL5 - sblim-1-31.el5_2.1

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Standards Based Linux Instrumentation for Manageability

Description:

SBLIM stands for Standards Based Linux Instrumentation for

170
12. Updated Packages

Manageability,
and consists of a set of standards based Web Based Enterprise
Management
(WBEM) modules that use the Common Information Model (CIM)
standard to
gather and provide systems management information, events, and
methods
to local or networked consumers via an CIM object services broker
using
the CMPI (Common Manageability Programming Interface) standard.
This package provides a set of core providers and development
tools
for systems management applications.

Added Dependencies:

sed

No removed dependencies

scim-1.4.4-39.el5 - scim-1.4.4-41.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Smart Common Input Method platform

Description:

SCIM is a user friendly and full featured input method user


interface and
also a development platform to make life easier for Input Method
developers.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

scim-anthy-1.2.0-5.el5 - scim-anthy-1.2.0-6.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: SCIM IMEngine for anthy for Japanese input

Description:

Scim-anthy is a SCIM IMEngine module for anthy to support Japanese


input.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

scim-bridge-0.4.5-7.el5 - scim-bridge-0.4.5-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: SCIM Bridge Gtk IM module

171
5.3 Release Notes

Description:

SCIM Bridge is a C implementation of a Gtk IM module for SCIM.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

scim-chewing-0.3.1-10.el5 - scim-chewing-0.3.1-11.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Chewing Chinese input method for SCIM

Description:

This package provides Chewing Chinese input method for SCIM.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

scim-pinyin-0.5.91-15.el5 - scim-pinyin-0.5.91-16.el5

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Smart Pinyin IMEngine for Smart Common Input Method platform

Description:

Simplified Chinese Smart Pinyin IMEngine for SCIM.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

scsi-target-utils-0.0-0.20070620snap.el5 - scsi-target-utils-0.0-5.20080917snap.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The SCSI target daemon and utility programs

Description:

The SCSI target package contains the daemon and tools to setup a
SCSI targets.
Currently, software iSCSI targets are supported.

Added Dependencies:

libibverbs-devel

librdmacm-devel

No removed dependencies

selinux-policy-2.4.6-104.el5 - selinux-policy-2.4.6-203.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

172
12. Updated Packages

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: SELinux policy configuration

Description:

SELinux Reference Policy - modular.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

setroubleshoot-1.8.11-4.el5 - setroubleshoot-2.0.5-3.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Helps troubleshoot SELinux problems

Description:

setroubleshoot gui. Application that allows you to view


setroubleshoot-server
messages.
Provides tools to help diagnose SELinux problems. When AVC
messages
are generated an alert can be generated that will give information
about the problem and help track its resolution. Alerts can be
configured
to user preference. The same tools can be run on existing log
files.

Added Dependencies:

desktop-file-utils

htmlview

No removed dependencies

setup-2.5.58-1.el5 - setup-2.5.58-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A set of system configuration and setup files.

Description:

The setup package contains a set of important system configuration


and
setup files, such as passwd, group, and profile.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

sg3_utils-1.20-2.1 - sg3_utils-1.25-1.el5

Group: Utilities/System

173
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: Utils for Linux's SCSI generic driver devices + raw devices

Description:

Collection of Linux utilities for devices that use the SCSI


command set.
Includes utilities to copy data based on "dd" syntax and semantics
(called
sg_dd, sgp_dd and sgm_dd); check INQUIRY data and VPD pages
(sg_inq); check
mode and log pages (sginfo, sg_modes and sg_logs); spin up and down
disks (sg_start); do self tests (sg_senddiag); and various other
functions.
See the README, CHANGELOG and COVERAGE files. Requires the linux
kernel 2.4
series or later. In the 2.4 series SCSI generic device names (e.g.
/dev/sg0)
must be used. In the 2.6 series other device names may be used as
well (e.g. /dev/sda).

Warning: Some of these tools access the internals of your system


and the incorrect usage of them may render your system inoperable.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

shadow-utils-4.0.17-12.el5 - shadow-utils-4.0.17-14.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Utilities for managing accounts and shadow password files.

Description:

The shadow-utils package includes the necessary programs for


converting UNIX password files to the shadow password format, plus
programs for managing user and group accounts. The pwconv command
converts passwords to the shadow password format. The pwunconv
command
unconverts shadow passwords and generates an npasswd file (a
standard
UNIX password file). The pwck command checks the integrity of
password
and shadow files. The lastlog command prints out the last login
times
for all users. The useradd, userdel, and usermod commands are used
for
managing user accounts. The groupadd, groupdel, and groupmod
commands
are used for managing group accounts.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

shared-mime-info-0.19-3.el5 - shared-mime-info-0.19-5.el5

174
12. Updated Packages

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: Shared MIME information database

Description:

This is the freedesktop.org shared MIME info database.

Many programs and desktops use the MIME system to represent the
types of
files. Frequently, it is necessary to work out the correct MIME
type for
a file. This is generally done by examining the file's name or
contents,
and looking up the correct MIME type in a database.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

smartmontools-5.36-3.1.el5 - smartmontools-5.38-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Tools for monitoring SMART capable hard disks

Description:

The smartmontools package contains two utility programs (smartctl


and smartd) to control and monitor storage systems using the Self-
Monitoring, Analysis and Reporting Technology System (SMART) built
into most modern ATA and SCSI hard disks. In many cases, these
utilities will provide advanced warning of disk degradation and
failure.

Added Dependencies:

libselinux-devel

No removed dependencies

sos-1.7-9.1.el5 - sos-1.7-9.16.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A set of tools to gather troubleshooting information from a


system

Description:

Sos is a set of tools that gathers information about system


hardware and configuration. The information can then be used for
diagnostic purposes and debugging. Sos is commonly used to help
support technicians and developers.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

175
5.3 Release Notes

spamassassin-3.1.9-1.el5 - spamassassin-3.2.5-1.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Spam filter for email which can be invoked from mail delivery
agents.

Description:

SpamAssassin provides you with a way to reduce if not completely


eliminate
Unsolicited Commercial Email (SPAM) from your incoming email. It
can
be invoked by a MDA such as sendmail or postfix, or can be called
from
a procmail script, .forward file, etc. It uses a genetic-algorithm
evolved scoring system to identify messages which look spammy,
then
adds headers to the message so they can be filtered by the user's
mail
reading software. This distribution includes the spamd/spamc
components
which create a server that considerably speeds processing of mail.

To enable spamassassin, if you are receiving mail locally, simply


add
this line to your ~/.procmailrc:
INCLUDERC=/etc/mail/spamassassin/spamassassin-default.rc

To filter spam for all users, add that line to /etc/procmailrc


(creating if necessary).

Added Dependencies:

perl-HTML-Parser >= 3.43

No removed dependencies

speex-1.0.5-4 - speex-1.0.5-4.el5_1.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A voice compression format (codec)

Description:

Speex is a patent-free compression format designed especially for


speech. It is specialized for voice communications at low bit-
rates in
the 2-45 kbps range. Possible applications include Voice over IP
(VoIP), Internet audio streaming, audio books, and archiving of
speech
data (e.g. voice mail).

No added dependencies

176
12. Updated Packages

No removed dependencies

squid-2.6.STABLE6-4.el5 - squid-2.6.STABLE21-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The Squid proxy caching server.

Description:

Squid is a high-performance proxy caching server for Web clients,


supporting FTP, gopher, and HTTP data objects. Unlike traditional
caching software, Squid handles all requests in a single,
non-blocking, I/O-driven process. Squid keeps meta data and
especially
hot objects cached in RAM, caches DNS lookups, supports non-
blocking
DNS lookups, and implements negative caching of failed requests.

Squid consists of a main server program squid, a Domain Name


System
lookup program (dnsserver), a program for retrieving FTP data
(ftpget), and some management and client tools.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

strace-4.5.16-1.el5.1 - strace-4.5.18-2.el5

Group: Development/Debuggers

Summary: Tracks and displays system calls associated with a running


process

Description:

The strace program intercepts and records the system calls called
and
received by a running process. Strace can print a record of each
system call, its arguments and its return value. Strace is useful
for
diagnosing problems and debugging, as well as for instructional
purposes.

Install strace if you need a tool to track the system calls made
and
received by a process.

Added Dependencies:

libacl-devel

libaio-devel

No removed dependencies

stunnel-4.15-2 - stunnel-4.15-2.el5.1

177
5.3 Release Notes

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: An SSL-encrypting socket wrapper.

Description:

Stunnel is a socket wrapper which can provide SSL (Secure Sockets


Layer) support to ordinary applications. For example, it can be
used
in conjunction with imapd to create an SSL secure IMAP server.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

subversion-1.4.2-2.el5 - subversion-1.4.2-4.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: Modern Version Control System designed to replace CVS

Description:

Subversion is a concurrent version control system which enables


one
or more users to collaborate in developing and maintaining a
hierarchy of files and directories while keeping a history of all
changes. Subversion only stores the differences between versions,
instead of every complete file. Subversion is intended to be a
compelling replacement for CVS.

Added Dependencies:

neon-devel >= 0:0.25.5-6.el5

Removed Dependencies:

neon-devel >= 0:0.24.7-1

sudo-1.6.8p12-10 - sudo-1.6.9p17-3.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Allows restricted root access for specified users.

Description:

Sudo (superuser do) allows a system administrator to give certain


users (or groups of users) the ability to run some (or all)
commands
as root while logging all commands and arguments. Sudo operates on
a
per-command basis. It is not a replacement for the shell. Features
include: the ability to restrict what commands a user may run on a
per-host basis, copious logging of each command (providing a clear

178
12. Updated Packages

audit trail of who did what), a configurable timeout of the sudo


command, and the ability to use the same configuration file
(sudoers)
on many different machines.

Added Dependencies:

audit-libs-devel

autoconf

automake

libcap-devel

libtool

No removed dependencies

sysklogd-1.4.1-40.el5 - sysklogd-1.4.1-44.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: System logging and kernel message trapping daemons.

Description:

The sysklogd package contains two system utilities (syslogd and


klogd)
which provide support for system logging. Syslogd and klogd run as
daemons (background processes) and log system messages to
different
places, like sendmail logs, security logs, error logs, etc.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

sysstat-7.0.0-3.el5 - sysstat-7.0.2-3.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: The sar and iostat system monitoring commands.

Description:

This package provides the sar and iostat commands for Linux. Sar
and
iostat enable system monitoring of disk, network, and other IO
activity.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-bind-4.0.3-2.el5 - system-config-bind-4.0.3-4.el5

Group: Applications/System

179
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: The Red Hat BIND DNS Configuration Tool.

Description:

The system-config-bind package provides a graphical user interface


(GUI) to
configure the Berkeley Internet Name Domain (BIND) Domain Name
System (DNS)
server, "named", with a set of python modules.
Users new to BIND configuration can use this tool to quickly set
up a working
DNS server.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-cluster-1.0.50-1.3 - system-config-cluster-1.0.55-1.0

Group: Applications/System

Summary: system-config-cluster is a utility which allows you to manage


cluster configuration in a graphical setting.

Description:

system-config-cluster is a utility which allows you to manage


cluster configuuration in a graphical setting.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-date-1.8.12-1.el5 - system-config-date-1.8.12-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A graphical interface for modifying system date and time

Description:

system-config-date is a graphical interface for changing the system


date and
time, configuring the system time zone, and setting up the NTP
daemon to
synchronize the time of the system with an NTP time server.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-httpd-1.3.3.1-1.el5 - system-config-httpd-1.3.3.3-1.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Apache configuration tool

Description:

180
12. Updated Packages

A RHN configuration tool for apache.

Added Dependencies:

gettext

No removed dependencies

system-config-kdump-1.0.12-1.el5 - system-config-kdump-1.0.14-4.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A graphical interface for configuring kernel crash dumping

Description:

system-config-kdump is a graphical tool for configuring kernel


crash
dumping via kdump and kexec.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-kickstart-2.6.19.1-1.el5 - system-config-kickstart-2.6.19.8-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A graphical interface for making kickstart files.

Description:

Kickstart Configurator is a graphical tool for creating kickstart


files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-language-1.1.18-1.el5 - system-config-language-1.1.18-2.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A graphical interface for modifying the system language

Description:

system-config-language is a graphical user interface that


allows the user to change the default language of the system.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-lvm-1.0.22-1.0.el5 - system-config-lvm-1.1.5-1.0.el5

Group: Applications/System

181
5.3 Release Notes

Summary: A utility for graphically configuring Logical Volumes

Description:

system-config-lvm is a utility for graphically configuring Logical


Volumes

Added Dependencies:

intltool

No removed dependencies

system-config-network-1.3.99-2.el5 - system-config-network-1.3.99.12-1.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: The GUI of the NEtwork Adminstration Tool

Description:

This is the GUI of the network configuration tool,


supporting Ethernet, Wireless, TokenRing, ADSL, ISDN and PPP.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-printer-0.7.32.5-1.el5 - system-config-printer-0.7.32.10-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A printer administration tool

Description:

system-config-printer is a graphical user interface that allows


the user to configure a CUPS print server.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-samba-1.2.39-1.el5 - system-config-samba-1.2.41-3.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Samba server configuration tool

Description:

system-config-samba is a graphical user interface for creating,


modifying, and deleting samba shares.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

182
12. Updated Packages

system-config-securitylevel-1.6.29.1-1.el5 - system-config-securitylevel-1.6.29.1-2.1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A graphical interface for modifying the system security level

Description:

system-config-securitylevel is a graphical user interface for


setting basic firewall rules.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

system-config-users-1.2.51-1.el5 - system-config-users-1.2.51-4.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A graphical interface for administering users and groups

Description:

system-config-users is a graphical utility for administrating


users and groups. It depends on the libuser library.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

systemtap-0.5.14-1.el5 - systemtap-0.7.2-2.el5

Group: Development/System

Summary: Instrumentation System

Description:

SystemTap is an instrumentation system for systems running Linux


2.6.
Developers can write instrumentation to collect data on the
operation
of the system.

Added Dependencies:

/usr/bin/dvips

/usr/bin/latex

/usr/bin/ps2pdf

crash-devel

elfutils-devel >= 0.127

latex2html

zlib-devel

183
5.3 Release Notes

Removed Dependencies:

dejagnu

glib2-devel >= 2.0.0

tcp_wrappers-7.6-40.4.el5 - tcp_wrappers-7.6-40.6.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: A security tool which acts as a wrapper for TCP daemons.

Description:

The tcp_wrappers package provides small daemon programs which can


monitor and filter incoming requests for systat, finger, FTP,
telnet,
rlogin, rsh, exec, tftp, talk and other network services.

Install the tcp_wrappers program if you need a security tool for


filtering incoming network services requests.

This version also supports IPv6.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

tcpdump-3.9.4-11.el5 - tcpdump-3.9.4-14.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: A network traffic monitoring tool.

Description:

Tcpdump is a command-line tool for monitoring network traffic.


Tcpdump can capture and display the packet headers on a particular
network interface or on all interfaces. Tcpdump can display all of
the packet headers, or just the ones that match particular
criteria.

Install tcpdump if you need a program to monitor network traffic.

Added Dependencies:

/usr/sbin/sendmail

No removed dependencies

tcsh-6.14-12.el5 - tcsh-6.14-14.el5

Group: System Environment/Shells

Summary: An enhanced version of csh, the C shell.

Description:

184
12. Updated Packages

Tcsh is an enhanced but completely compatible version of csh, the


C
shell. Tcsh is a command language interpreter which can be used
both
as an interactive login shell and as a shell script command
processor.
Tcsh includes a command line editor, programmable word completion,
spelling correction, a history mechanism, job control and a C
language
like syntax.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

telnet-0.17-38.el5 - telnet-0.17-39.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: The client program for the telnet remote login protocol.

Description:

Telnet is a popular protocol for logging into remote systems over


the
Internet. The telnet package provides a command line telnet
client.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

tetex-3.0-33.1.el5 - tetex-3.0-33.2.el5_1.2

Group: Applications/Publishing

Summary: The TeX text formatting system.

Description:

TeTeX is an implementation of TeX for Linux or UNIX systems. TeX


takes
a text file and a set of formatting commands as input and creates
a
typesetter-independent .dvi (DeVice Independent) file as output.
Usually, TeX is used in conjunction with a higher level formatting
package like LaTeX or PlainTeX, since TeX by itself is not very
user-friendly. The output format needn't to be DVI, but also PDF,
when using pdflatex or similar tools.

Install tetex if you want to use the TeX text formatting system.
Consider
to install tetex-latex (a higher level formatting package which
provides

185
5.3 Release Notes

an easier-to-use interface for TeX). Unless you are an expert at


using TeX,
you should also install the tetex-doc package, which includes the
documentation for TeX.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

tk-8.4.13-3.fc6 - tk-8.4.13-5.el5_1.1

Group: Development/Languages

Summary: Tk graphical toolkit for the Tcl scripting language

Description:

When paired with the Tcl scripting language, Tk provides a fast and
powerful
way to create cross-platform GUI applications.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

tmpwatch-2.9.7-1.1.el5.1 - tmpwatch-2.9.7-1.1.el5.2

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A utility for removing files based on when they were last
accessed.

Description:

The tmpwatch utility recursively searches through specified


directories and removes files which have not been accessed in a
specified period of time. Tmpwatch is normally used to clean up
directories which are used for temporarily holding files (for
example,
/tmp). Tmpwatch ignores symlinks, won't switch filesystems and
only
removes empty directories and regular files.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

tog-pegasus-2.6.1-2.el5 - tog-pegasus-2.7.1-2.el5

Group: Systems Management/Base

Summary: OpenPegasus WBEM Services for Linux

Description:

OpenPegasus WBEM Services for Linux enables management solutions


that deliver
increased control of enterprise resources. WBEM is a platform and

186
12. Updated Packages

resource
independent DMTF standard that defines a common information model
and
communication protocol for monitoring and controlling resources
from diverse
sources.

Added Dependencies:

net-snmp-devel

No removed dependencies

tomcat5-5.5.23-0jpp.3.0.2.el5 - tomcat5-5.5.23-0jpp.7.el5_2.1

Group: Networking/Daemons

Summary: Apache Servlet/JSP Engine, RI for Servlet 2.4/JSP 2.0 API

Description:

Tomcat is the servlet container that is used in the official


Reference
Implementation for the Java Servlet and JavaServer Pages
technologies.
The Java Servlet and JavaServer Pages specifications are developed
by
Sun under the Java Community Process.

Tomcat is developed in an open and participatory environment and


released under the Apache Software License. Tomcat is intended to
be
a collaboration of the best-of-breed developers from around the
world.
We invite you to participate in this open development project. To
learn more about getting involved, click here.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

totem-2.16.7-1.el5 - totem-2.16.7-4.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: Movie player for GNOME 2

Description:

Totem is simple movie player for the Gnome desktop. It features a


simple playlist, a full-screen mode, seek and volume controls, as
well as
a pretty complete keyboard navigation.

Added Dependencies:

gecko-devel-unstable >= 1.9

187
5.3 Release Notes

Removed Dependencies:

firefox-devel

traceroute-2.0.1-2.el5 - traceroute-2.0.1-5.el5

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Traces the route taken by packets over an IPv4/IPv6 network

Description:

The traceroute utility displays the route used by IP packets on


their
way to a specified network (or Internet) host. Traceroute displays
the IP number and host name (if possible) of the machines along
the
route taken by the packets. Traceroute is used as a network
debugging
tool. If you're having network connectivity problems, traceroute
will
show you where the trouble is coming from along the route.

Install traceroute if you need a tool for diagnosing network


connectivity
problems.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

tzdata-2007d-1.el5 - tzdata-2008i-1.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Timezone data

Description:

This package contains data files with rules for various timezones
around
the world.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

udev-095-14.9.el5 - udev-095-14.19.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A userspace implementation of devfs

Description:

The udev package contains an implementation of devfs in


userspace using sysfs and netlink.

188
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

unzip-5.52-2.2.1 - unzip-5.52-3.el5

Group: Applications/Archiving

Summary: A utility for unpacking zip files.

Description:

The unzip utility is used to list, test, or extract files from a


zip
archive. Zip archives are commonly found on MS-DOS systems. The zip
utility, included in the zip package, creates zip archives. Zip and
unzip are both compatible with archives created by PKWARE(R)'s
PKZIP
for MS-DOS, but the programs' options and default behaviors do
differ
in some respects.

Install the unzip package if you need to list, test or extract


files from
a zip archive.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

usermode-1.88-3.el5 - usermode-1.88-3.el5.2

Group: Applications/System

Summary: Tools for certain user account management tasks.

Description:

The usermode package contains the userhelper program, which can be


used to allow configured programs to be run with superuser
privileges
by ordinary users.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

util-linux-2.13-0.45.el5 - util-linux-2.13-0.50.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: A collection of basic system utilities.

Description:

The util-linux package contains a large variety of low-level


system
utilities that are necessary for a Linux system to function. Among

189
5.3 Release Notes

others, Util-linux contains the fdisk configuration tool and the


login
program.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

vim-7.0.109-3.el5.3 - vim-7.0.109-4.el5_2.4z

Group: Applications/Editors

Summary: The VIM editor.

Description:

VIM (VIsual editor iMproved) is an updated and improved version of


the
vi editor. Vi was the first real screen-based editor for UNIX, and
is
still very popular. VIM improves on vi by adding new features:
multiple windows, multi-level undo, block highlighting and more.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

virt-manager-0.4.0-3.el5 - virt-manager-0.5.3-10.el5

Group: Applications/Emulators

Summary: Virtual Machine Manager

Description:

Virtual Machine Manager provides a graphical tool for


administering
virtual machines such as Xen. It uses libvirt as the backend
management
API.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

vixie-cron-4.1-72.el5 - vixie-cron-4.1-76.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: The Vixie cron daemon for executing specified programs at set
times.

Description:

The vixie-cron package contains the Vixie version of cron. Cron is


a
standard UNIX daemon that runs specified programs at scheduled
times.

190
12. Updated Packages

Vixie cron adds better security and more powerful configuration


options to the standard version of cron.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

vnc-4.1.2-9.el5 - vnc-4.1.2-14.el5

Group: User Interface/Desktops

Summary: A remote display system.

Description:

Virtual Network Computing (VNC) is a remote display system which


allows you to view a computing 'desktop' environment not only on
the
machine where it is running, but from anywhere on the Internet and
from a wide variety of machine architectures. This package
contains a
client which will allow you to connect to other desktops running a
VNC
server.

Added Dependencies:

libselinux-devel

mesa-source

Removed Dependencies:

libdrm-devel

vsftpd-2.0.5-10.el5 - vsftpd-2.0.5-12.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: vsftpd - Very Secure Ftp Daemon

Description:

vsftpd is a Very Secure FTP daemon. It was written completely from


scratch.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

wireshark-0.99.6-1.el5 - wireshark-1.0.3-4.el5_2

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: Network traffic analyzer

Description:

Wireshark is a network traffic analyzer for Unix-ish operating

191
5.3 Release Notes

systems.

This package lays base for libpcap, a packet capture and filtering
library, contains command-line utilities, contains plugins and
documentation for wireshark. A graphical user interface is
packaged
separately to GTK+ package.

Added Dependencies:

bison

flex

libsmi-devel

Removed Dependencies:

net-snmp-devel >= 5.3

net-snmp-utils >= 5.3

words-3.0-9 - words-3.0-9.1

Group: System Environment/Libraries

Summary: A dictionary of English words for the /usr/share/dict


directory.

Description:

The words file is a dictionary of English words for the


/usr/share/dict directory. Some programs use this database of
words to check spelling. Password checkers use it to look for bad
passwords.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

wpa_supplicant-0.4.8-10.1.fc6 - wpa_supplicant-0.5.10-8.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: WPA/WPA2/IEEE 802.1X Supplicant

Description:

wpa_supplicant is a WPA Supplicant for Linux, BSD and Windows with


support
for WPA and WPA2 (IEEE 802.11i / RSN). Supplicant is the IEEE
802.1X/WPA
component that is used in the client stations. It implements key
negotiation
with a WPA Authenticator and it controls the roaming and IEEE
802.11
authentication/association of the wlan driver.

192
12. Updated Packages

Added Dependencies:

dbus-devel

No removed dependencies

x3270-3.3.4p7-3.el5.1 - x3270-3.3.4p7-3.el5.4

Group: Applications/Internet

Summary: An X Window System based IBM 3278/3279 terminal emulator

Description:

The x3270 package contains files needed for emulating the IBM
3278/3279
terminals, commonly used with mainframe applications.

You will also need to install a frontend for x3270. Available


frontends
are x3270-x11 (for the X Window System) and x3270-text (for text
mode).

Added Dependencies:

/usr/bin/makeconv

libicu-devel

No removed dependencies

xen-3.0.3-41.el5 - xen-3.0.3-80.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: Xen is a virtual machine monitor

Description:

This package contains the Xen tools and management daemons needed
to run virtual machines on x86, x86_64, and ia64 systems.
Information on how to use Xen can be found at the Xen project
pages.

The Xen system also requires the Xen hypervisor and domain-0
kernel, which can be found in the kernel-xen* package.

Virtualization can be used to run multiple operating systems on


one
physical system, for purposes of hardware consolidation, hardware
abstraction, or to test untrusted applications in a sandboxed
environment.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xfig-3.2.4-21.2.el5 - xfig-3.2.4-21.3.el5

193
5.3 Release Notes

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: An X Window System tool for drawing basic vector graphics.

Description:

Xfig is an X Window System tool for creating basic vector


graphics,
including bezier curves, lines, rulers and more. The resulting
graphics can be saved, printed on PostScript printers or converted
to
a variety of other formats (e.g., X11 bitmaps, Encapsulated
PostScript, LaTeX).

You should install xfig if you need a simple program to create


vector
graphics.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-drv-ati-6.6.3-3.2.el5 - xorg-x11-drv-ati-6.6.3-3.22.el5

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 ati video driver

Description:

X.Org X11 ati video driver.

Added Dependencies:

autoconf

automake

libtool

xorg-x11-server-randr-source >= 1.1.1-48.52.el5

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-drv-i810-1.6.5-9.6.el5 - xorg-x11-drv-i810-1.6.5-9.21.el5

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 i810 video driver(s)

Description:

X.Org X11 i810 video driver.

Added Dependencies:

xorg-x11-server-randr-source >= 1.1.1-48.46.el5

194
12. Updated Packages

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-drv-keyboard-1.1.0-2.1 - xorg-x11-drv-keyboard-1.1.0-3

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 keyboard input driver

Description:

X.Org X11 keyboard input driver.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-drv-mga-1.4.2-6.el5 - xorg-x11-drv-mga-1.4.2-10.el5

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 mga video driver

Description:

X.Org X11 mga video driver.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-drv-mutouch-1.1.0-2 - xorg-x11-drv-mutouch-1.1.0-3

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 mutouch input driver

Description:

X.Org X11 mutouch input driver.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-drv-nv-2.1.2-1.el5 - xorg-x11-drv-nv-2.1.12-3.el5

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 nv video driver

Description:

X.Org X11 nv video driver.

Added Dependencies:

xorg-x11-server-randr-source >= 1.1.1-48.46.el5

No removed dependencies

195
5.3 Release Notes

xorg-x11-drv-sis-0.9.1-7 - xorg-x11-drv-sis-0.9.1-7.1.el5

Group: User Interface/X Hardware Support

Summary: Xorg X11 sis video driver

Description:

X.Org X11 sis video driver.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-server-1.1.1-48.26.el5 - xorg-x11-server-1.1.1-48.52.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: X.Org X11 X server

Description:

X.Org X11 X server

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xorg-x11-xinit-1.0.2-13.el5 - xorg-x11-xinit-1.0.2-15.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: X.Org X11 X Window System xinit startup scripts

Description:

X.Org X11 X Window System xinit startup scripts

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xsane-0.991-4.el5 - xsane-0.991-5.el5

Group: Applications/Multimedia

Summary: An X Window System front-end for the SANE scanner interface.

Description:

XSane is an X based interface for the SANE (Scanner Access Now


Easy)
library, which provides access to scanners, digital cameras, and
other
capture devices. XSane is written in GTK+ and provides control for
performing the scan and then manipulating the captured image.

196
12. Updated Packages

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

xterm-215-5.el5 - xterm-215-8.el5

Group: User Interface/X

Summary: xterm terminal emulator for the X Window System

Description:

The xterm program is a terminal emulator for the X Window System.


It
provides DEC VT102 and Tektronix 4014 compatible terminals for
programs that can't use the window system directly.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

yaboot-1.3.13-5.el5 - yaboot-1.3.13-7.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: Linux bootloader for Power Macintosh "New World" computers.

Description:

yaboot is a bootloader for PowerPC machines which works on New


World ROM
machines (Rev. A iMac and newer) and runs directly from Open
Firmware,
eliminating the need for Mac OS.
yaboot can also bootload IBM pSeries machines.

Added Dependencies:

e2fsprogs-devel

No removed dependencies

yelp-2.16.0-15.el5 - yelp-2.16.0-22.el5

Group: Applications/System

Summary: A system documentation reader from the Gnome project

Description:

Yelp is the Gnome 2 help/documentation browser. It is designed


to help you browse all the documentation on your system in
one central tool.

Added Dependencies:

gecko-devel-unstable >= 1.9

197
5.3 Release Notes

Removed Dependencies:

gecko-devel >= 1.8.0.12

ypbind-1.19-8.el5 - ypbind-1.19-11.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The NIS daemon which binds NIS clients to an NIS domain.

Description:

The Network Information Service (NIS) is a system that provides


network information (login names, passwords, home directories,
group
information) to all of the machines on a network. NIS can allow
users
to log in on any machine on the network, as long as the machine
has
the NIS client programs running and the user's password is recorded
in
the NIS passwd database. NIS was formerly known as Sun Yellow
Pages
(YP).

This package provides the ypbind daemon. The ypbind daemon binds
NIS
clients to an NIS domain. Ypbind must be running on any machines
running NIS client programs.

Install the ypbind package on any machines running NIS client


programs
(included in the yp-tools package). If you need an NIS server, you
also need to install the ypserv package to a machine on your
network.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

ypserv-2.19-3 - ypserv-2.19-5.el5

Group: System Environment/Daemons

Summary: The NIS (Network Information Service) server.

Description:

The Network Information Service (NIS) is a system that provides


network information (login names, passwords, home directories,
group
information) to all of the machines on a network. NIS can allow
users
to log in on any machine on the network, as long as the machine
has
the NIS client programs running and the user's password is recorded
in
the NIS passwd database. NIS was formerly known as Sun Yellow

198
12. Updated Packages

Pages
(YP).

This package provides the NIS server, which will need to be


running on
your network. NIS clients do not need to be running the server.

Install ypserv if you need an NIS server for your network. You also
need to install the yp-tools and ypbind packages on any NIS client
machines.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

yum-3.0.1-5.el5 - yum-3.2.19-18.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: RPM installer/updater

Description:

Yum is a utility that can check for and automatically download and
install updated RPM packages. Dependencies are obtained and
downloaded
automatically prompting the user as necessary.

Added Dependencies:

intltool

No removed dependencies

yum-metadata-parser-1.0-8.fc6 - yum-metadata-parser-1.1.2-2.el5

Group: Development/Libraries

Summary: A fast metadata parser for yum

Description:

Fast metadata parser for yum implemented in C.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

yum-rhn-plugin-0.5.2-3.el5 - yum-rhn-plugin-0.5.3-30.el5

Group: System Environment/Base

Summary: RHN support for yum

Description:

199
5.3 Release Notes

This yum plugin provides support for yum to access a Red Hat
Network server for
software updates.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

yum-utils-1.0.4-3.el5 - yum-utils-1.1.16-13.el5

Group: Development/Tools

Summary: Utilities based around the yum package manager

Description:

yum-utils is a collection of utilities and examples for the yum


package
manager. It includes utilities by different authors that make yum
easier and
more powerful to use. These tools include: debuginfo-install,
package-cleanup,
repoclosure, repodiff, repo-graph, repomanage, repoquery, repo-
rss, reposync,
repotrack, verifytree, yum-builddep, yum-complete-transaction,
yumdownloader,
yum-debug-dump and yum-groups-manager.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

zip-2.31-1.2.2 - zip-2.31-2.el5

Group: Applications/Archiving

Summary: A file compression and packaging utility compatible with


PKZIP.

Description:

The zip program is a compression and file packaging utility. Zip


is
analogous to a combination of the UNIX tar and compress commands
and
is compatible with PKZIP (a compression and file packaging utility
for
MS-DOS systems).

Install the zip package if you need to compress files using the
zip
program.

No added dependencies

No removed dependencies

200
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

iscsi-initiator-utils-6.2.0.868-0.7.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/iscsid
---
+++
@@ -59,9 +59,7 @@

echo -n $"Stopping iSCSI daemon: "

- # iscsid does not have a nice shutdown process.


- # It really should never be stopped
- pkill -KILL iscsid
+ iscsiadm -k 0
echo

modprobe -r ib_iser 2>/dev/null


ypbind-1.19-8.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/ypbind
---
+++
@@ -37,7 +37,7 @@
[ -x /usr/sbin/selinuxenabled ] && /usr/sbin/selinuxenabled ||
return
allow_ypbind=0
. /etc/selinux/config
- if [ -e /etc/selinux/${SELINUXTYPE}/modules1/active/booleans.local ]; then
+ if [ -e /etc/selinux/${SELINUXTYPE}/modules/active/booleans.local ]; then
. /etc/selinux/${SELINUXTYPE}/modules/active/booleans.local
fi
if [ $allow_ypbind == 0 ]; then
@@ -52,6 +52,7 @@
if [ -n "$NISDOMAIN" ]; then
action $"Setting NIS domain name $NISDOMAIN: " domainname $NISDOMAIN
else
+ action $"Error: NIS domain name is not set." false
exit 1
fi
fi
@@ -112,7 +113,7 @@
fi
fi
echo
- selinux_off
+ #selinux_off
return $RETVAL
}

udev-095-14.16.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/modules/udev-stw.modules
---
+++
@@ -1,4 +1,6 @@
#!/bin/sh
-for i in nvram floppy parport lp snd-powermac;do
+MODULES="nvram floppy parport lp snd-powermac"
+[ -f /etc/sysconfig/udev-stw ] && . /etc/sysconfig/udev-stw
+for i in $MODULES ; do

201
5.3 Release Notes

modprobe $i >/dev/null 2>&1


done
dhcp-3.0.5-13.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/dhcpd
---
+++
@@ -62,6 +62,11 @@
[ -f $conf ] || return 6
$dhcpd -q -t -cf $conf
RETVAL=$?
+ if [ $RETVAL -eq 1 ]; then
+ $dhcpd -t -cf $conf
+ else
+ echo "Syntax: OK" >&2
+ fi
return $RETVAL
}

initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/netconsole
---
+++
@@ -92,7 +92,7 @@

SYSLOGOPTS="netconsole=$LOCALPORT@$LOCALADDR/$DEV,$SYSLOGPORT@$SYSLOGADDR/$S
YSLOGMACADDR "

- logger -p daemon.info -t netconsole: inserting netconsole module with


arguments \
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t netconsole: inserting netconsole module
with arguments \
$SYSLOGOPTS
if [ -n "$SYSLOGOPTS" ]; then
action $"Initializing netconsole" modprobe netconsole \
bind-9.3.4-6.P1.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/named
---
+++
@@ -253,7 +253,7 @@
fi
[ "$RETVAL" -eq 0 ] && success $"$named reload" || failure $"$named
reload"
echo
- return $?
+ return $RETVAL
}
probe() {
# named knows how to reload intelligently; we don't want linuxconf
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifup-ippp
---
+++
@@ -30,20 +30,20 @@
# check that ipppd is available for syncppp
if [ "$ENCAP" = "syncppp" ]; then
if [ ! -x /usr/sbin/ipppd -a ! -x /sbin/ipppd ] ; then
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "ipppd does not exist or is not
executable"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "ipppd does not exist

202
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

or is not executable"
exit 1
fi
fi

# check that isdnctrl is available


if [ ! -x /usr/sbin/isdnctrl -a ! -x /sbin/isdnctrl ] ; then
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "isdnctrl does not exist or is not
executable"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "isdnctrl does not exist or
is not executable"
exit 1
fi

# check all ISDN devices


if ! isdnctrl list all >/dev/null 2>&1 ; then
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "cannot list ISDN devices"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "cannot list ISDN devices"
exit 1
fi

@@ -52,12 +52,12 @@

function log_echo()
{
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp $"$*"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp $"$*"
}

function log_isdnctrl()
{
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp isdnctrl $*
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp isdnctrl $*
isdnctrl $* >/dev/null 2>&1 || exit 1
}

@@ -338,12 +338,12 @@
[ -n "$NETMASK" ] && netmask="netmask $NETMASK"

# activate ISDN device


- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "ifconfig $DEVICE $IPADDR
pointopoint $GATEWAY $netmask up"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "ifconfig $DEVICE $IPADDR
pointopoint $GATEWAY $netmask up"
ifconfig $DEVICE $IPADDR pointopoint $GATEWAY $netmask up >/dev/null
2>&1

if [ "$ENCAP" = "syncppp" ]; then


# start ipppd daemon
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "ipppd $options $netmask"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ippp "ipppd $options
$netmask"
ipppd $options $netmask >/dev/null 2>&1

# start ibod daemon


lynx-2.8.5-28.1.i386.rpm: /etc/lynx.cfg

203
5.3 Release Notes

---
+++
@@ -1026,7 +1026,7 @@
# ====
# Do not define this.
#
-#TRUSTED_LYNXCGI:none
+TRUSTED_LYNXCGI:none

.h2 LYNXCGI_ENVIRONMENT
nfs-utils-1.0.9-33.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/rpcgssd
---
+++
@@ -28,19 +28,23 @@
case "$1" in
start|condstart)
# Check that networking is up.
- [ "${NETWORKING}" = "no" ] && exit 6
+ [ "${NETWORKING}" != "yes" ] && exit 6
[ ! -x /usr/sbin/rpc.gssd ] && exit 5
-
- # List of kernel modules to load
- [ -z "${SECURE_NFS_MODS}" ] && SECURE_NFS_MODS="des rpcsec_gss_krb5"

# Make sure the daemon is not already running.


if status $prog > /dev/null ; then
exit 0
fi
+
+ # During condstart need to check again to see
+ # if we are configured to start
+ [ "${SECURE_NFS}" != "yes" ] && exit 6
+
rm -f $LOCKFILE
+ echo -n $"Starting RPC gssd: "

- echo -n $"Starting RPC gssd: "


+ # List of kernel modules to load
+ [ -z "${SECURE_NFS_MODS}" ] && SECURE_NFS_MODS="des rpcsec_gss_krb5"

# Make sure the rpc_pipefs filesystem is available


[ "${RPCMTAB}" != "noload" ] && {
dovecot-1.0.7-2.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/dovecot
---
+++
@@ -7,27 +7,61 @@
# chkconfig: - 65 35
# description: Dovecot Imap Server
# processname: dovecot
+# config: /etc/dovecot.conf
+# config: /etc/sysconfig/dovecot
+# pidfile: /var/run/dovecot/master.pid
+
+### BEGIN INIT INFO
+# Provides: dovecot

204
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

+# Required-Start: $local_fs $network


+# Required-Stop: $local_fs $network
+# Should-Start: $remote_fs
+# Should-Stop: $remote_fs
+# Default-Start:
+# Default-Stop: 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
+# Short-Description: start and stop Dovecot Imap server
+# Description: Dovecot is an IMAP server for Linux/UNIX-like systems,
+# written with security primarily in mind. It also contains
+# a small POP3 server.
+### END INIT INFO
+
# Source function library.
. /etc/init.d/functions

-test -x /usr/sbin/dovecot || exit 0


+if [ -f /etc/sysconfig/dovecot ]; then
+ . /etc/sysconfig/dovecot
+fi

RETVAL=0
prog="Dovecot Imap"
+exec="/usr/sbin/dovecot"
+config="/etc/dovecot.conf"
+pidfile="/var/run/dovecot/master.pid"
+lockfile="/var/lock/subsys/dovecot"

start() {
+ [ -x $exec ] || exit 5
+ [ -f $config ] || exit 6
+
echo -n $"Starting $prog: "
- daemon /usr/sbin/dovecot
+ daemon --pidfile $pidfile $exec $OPTIONS
RETVAL=$?
- [ $RETVAL -eq 0 ] && touch /var/lock/subsys/dovecot
+ [ $RETVAL -eq 0 ] && touch $lockfile
echo
}

stop() {
echo -n $"Stopping $prog: "
- killproc /usr/sbin/dovecot
+ killproc -p $pidfile $exec
RETVAL=$?
- [ $RETVAL -eq 0 ] && rm -f /var/lock/subsys/dovecot
+ [ $RETVAL -eq 0 ] && rm -f $lockfile
+ echo
+}
+
+reload() {
+ echo -n $"Reloading $prog: "
+ killproc -p $pidfile $exec -HUP
+ RETVAL=$?
echo
}

205
5.3 Release Notes

@@ -41,24 +75,27 @@
stop)
stop
;;
- reload|restart)
+ reload)
+ reload
+ ;;
+ force-reload|restart)
stop
start
RETVAL=$?
;;
- condrestart)
- if [ -f /var/lock/subsys/dovecot ]; then
+ condrestart|try-restart)
+ if [ -f $lockfile ]; then
stop
start
fi
;;
status)
- status /usr/sbin/dovecot
+ status -p $pidfile $exec
RETVAL=$?
;;
*)
- echo $"Usage: $0 {condrestart|start|stop|restart|reload|status}"
- exit 1
+ echo $"Usage: $0 {condrestart|try-restart|start|stop|restart|reload|force-
reload|status}"
+ exit 2
esac

exit $RETVAL
device-mapper-multipath-0.4.7-17.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/multipathd
---
+++
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
#
# Starts the multipath daemon
#
-# chkconfig: - 13 87
+# chkconfig: - 06 87
# description: Manage device-mapper multipath devices
# processname: multipathd

@@ -13,6 +13,7 @@
initdir=/etc/rc.d/init.d
lockdir=/var/lock/subsys
sysconfig=/etc/sysconfig
+syspath=/sys/block

system=redhat

206
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

@@ -25,6 +26,35 @@
test -r $sysconfig/$prog && . $sysconfig/$prog

RETVAL=0
+
+teardown_slaves()
+{
+cd $1;
+if [ -d "slaves" ]; then
+for slave in slaves/*;
+do
+ if [ "$slave" = "slaves/*" ]; then
+ read dev < $1/dev
+ tablename=`dmsetup table --target multipath | sed -n "s/\(.*\): .* $dev
.*/\1/p"`
+ if ! [ -z $tablename ]; then
+ echo "Root is on a multipathed device, multipathd can not be stopped"
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ else
+ local_slave=`readlink -f $slave`;
+ teardown_slaves $local_slave;
+ fi
+ done
+
+else
+ read dev < $1/dev
+ tablename=`dmsetup table --target multipath | sed -n "s/\(.*\): .* $dev
.*/\1/p"`
+ if ! [ -z $tablename ]; then
+ echo "Root is on a multipathed device, multipathd can not be stopped"
+ exit 1
+ fi
+fi
+}

#
# See how we were called.
@@ -40,6 +70,11 @@
}

stop() {
+ root_dev=$(awk '{ if ($1 !~ /^[ \t]*#/ && $2 == "/") { print $1;
}}' /etc/mtab)
+ dm_num=`dmsetup info -c --noheadings -o minor $root_dev`
+ root_dm_device="dm-$dm_num"
+ [ -d $syspath/$root_dm_device ] && teardown_slaves
$syspath/$root_dm_device
+
echo -n $"Stopping $prog daemon: "
killproc $DAEMON
RETVAL=$?
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/rc6.d/S01reboot
---
+++
@@ -10,6 +10,9 @@

207
5.3 Release Notes

NOLOCALE=1
. /etc/init.d/functions
+
+UMOUNT="umount"
+[ ! -w /etc ] && UMOUNT="umount -n"

action() {
echo -n "$1 "
@@ -131,7 +134,7 @@
# Try to unmount tmpfs filesystems to avoid swapping them in. Ignore
failures.
tmpfs=$(awk '$2 ~ /^\/($|proc|dev)/ { next; }
$3 == "tmpfs" { print $2; }' /proc/mounts | sort -r)
-[ -n "$tmpfs" ] && fstab-decode umount $tmpfs 2>/dev/null
+[ -n "$tmpfs" ] && fstab-decode $UMOUNT $tmpfs 2>/dev/null

# Turn off swap, then unmount file systems.


[ -f /proc/swaps ] && SWAPS=`awk '! /^Filename/ { print $1 }' /proc/swaps`
@@ -143,8 +146,6 @@
backdev=$(/sbin/cryptsetup status "$dst" \
| awk '$1 == "device:" { print $2 }')
/sbin/cryptsetup remove "$dst"
- # Leave partition with a blank plain-text swap
- mkswap "$backdev" > /dev/null
fi
done
fi
@@ -170,7 +171,7 @@
$"Unmounting file systems (retry): " \
-f

-[ -f /proc/bus/usb/devices ] && umount /proc/bus/usb


+[ -f /proc/bus/usb/devices ] && $UMOUNT /proc/bus/usb

[ -f /etc/crypttab ] && \
LANG=C action $"Stopping disk encryption: " halt_crypto
@@ -183,7 +184,7 @@
awk '$2 !~ /\/(|dev|proc|selinux)$/ && $1 !~ /^\/dev\/ram/ { print $2 }' \
/proc/mounts | sort -r | \
while read line; do
- fstab-decode umount -f $line
+ fstab-decode $UMOUNT -f $line
done

if [ -x /sbin/halt.local ]; then
alsa-lib-1.0.14-1.rc4.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/alsa/alsa.conf
---
+++
@@ -67,7 +67,7 @@
defaults.pcm.ipc_perm 0600
defaults.pcm.dmix.max_periods 0
defaults.pcm.dmix.rate 48000
-defaults.pcm.dmix.format S16_LE
+defaults.pcm.dmix.format "unchanged"
defaults.pcm.dmix.card defaults.pcm.card

208
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

defaults.pcm.dmix.device defaults.pcm.device
defaults.pcm.dsnoop.card defaults.pcm.card
@@ -94,6 +94,9 @@
defaults.pcm.iec958.device defaults.pcm.device
defaults.pcm.modem.card defaults.pcm.card
defaults.pcm.modem.device defaults.pcm.device
+# truncate files via file or tee PCM
+defaults.pcm.file_format "raw"
+defaults.pcm.file_truncate true
defaults.rawmidi.card 0
defaults.rawmidi.device 0
defaults.rawmidi.subdevice -1
@@ -124,6 +127,7 @@
pcm.surround71 cards.pcm.surround71
pcm.iec958 cards.pcm.iec958
pcm.spdif iec958
+pcm.hdmi cards.pcm.hdmi
pcm.dmix cards.pcm.dmix
pcm.dsnoop cards.pcm.dsnoop
pcm.modem cards.pcm.modem
@@ -262,12 +266,19 @@
}
@args.FORMAT {
type string
- default raw
+ default {
+ @func refer
+ name defaults.pcm.file_format
+ }
}
type file
slave.pcm $SLAVE
file $FILE
format $FORMAT
+ truncate {
+ @func refer
+ name defaults.pcm.file_truncate
+ }
}

pcm.file {
@@ -277,12 +288,19 @@
}
@args.FORMAT {
type string
- default raw
+ default {
+ @func refer
+ name defaults.pcm.file_format
+ }
}
type file
slave.pcm null
file $FILE
format $FORMAT
+ truncate {

209
5.3 Release Notes

+ @func refer
+ name defaults.pcm.file_truncate
+ }
}

pcm.null {
@@ -316,7 +334,7 @@
}

ctl.hw {
- @args[ CARD ]
+ @args [ CARD ]
@args.CARD {
type string
default {
caching-nameserver-9.3.4-6.P1.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/named.caching-
nameserver.conf
---
+++
@@ -18,8 +18,12 @@
dump-file "/var/named/data/cache_dump.db";
statistics-file "/var/named/data/named_stats.txt";
memstatistics-file "/var/named/data/named_mem_stats.txt";
- query-source port 53;
- query-source-v6 port 53;
+
+ // Those options should be used carefully because they disable port
+ // randomization
+ // query-source port 53;
+ // query-source-v6 port 53;
+
allow-query { localhost; };
};
logging {
kexec-tools-1.102pre-21.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/kdump
---
+++
@@ -26,6 +26,7 @@
KDUMP_KERNELVER=""
KDUMP_INITRDEXT=""
KDUMP_COMMANDLINE=""
+KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE=""
KEXEC_ARGS=""
KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE="/etc/kdump.conf"

@@ -107,8 +108,15 @@
#check to see if config file or kdump post has been modified
#since last build of the image file
image_time=`stat -c "%Y" $kdump_initrd`
- KDUMP_POST=`grep ^kdump_post $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE | cut -d\ -f2`
- files="$KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE $kdump_kernel $KDUMP_POST"
+ EXTRA_FILES=`grep ^kdump_post $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE | cut -d\ -f2`
+ CHECK_FILE=`grep ^kdump_pre $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE | cut -d\ -f2`
+ EXTRA_FILES="$EXTRA_FILES $CHECK_FILE"
+ CHECK_FILE=`grep ^extra_modules $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE | cut -d\ -f2-`
+ EXTRA_FILES="$EXTRA_FILES $CHECK_FILE"

210
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

+ CHECK_FILE=`grep ^extra_bins $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE | cut -d\ -f2-`


+ EXTRA_FILES="$EXTRA_FILES $CHECK_FILE"
+ FORCE_REBUILD=`grep ^extra_modules $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE`
+ files="$KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE $kdump_kernel $EXTRA_FILES"
modified_files=""
for file in $files; do
time_stamp=0
@@ -123,9 +131,17 @@
fi
done

- if [ -n "$modified_files" -a "$modified_files" != " " ]; then


- echo "Detected change(s) the following file(s):"
- echo -n " "; echo "$modified_files" | sed 's/\s/\n /g'
+ if [ -n "$FORCE_REBUILD" -a "$modified_files"!=" " ]
+ then
+ modified_files="force_rebuild"
+ fi
+
+ if [ -n "$modified_files" -a "$modified_files"!=" " ]; then
+ if [ "$modified_files" != "force_rebuild" ]
+ then
+ echo "Detected change(s) the following file(s):"
+ echo -n " "; echo "$modified_files" | sed 's/\s/\n /g'
+ fi
echo "Rebuilding $kdump_initrd"
/sbin/mkdumprd -d -f $kdump_initrd $kdump_kver
if [ $? != 0 ]; then
@@ -174,6 +190,33 @@
return 1
fi
return 0
+}
+
+function avoid_cdrom_drive()
+{
+ local DRIVE=""
+ local MEDIA=""
+ local IDE_DRIVES=(`echo hd{a,b,c,d}`)
+ local COUNTER="0"
+
+ for DRIVE in ${IDE_DRIVES[@]}
+ do
+ if ! $(echo "$KDUMP_COMMANDLINE" |grep -q "$DRIVE=");then
+ if [ -f /proc/ide/$DRIVE/media ];then
+ MEDIA=$(cat /proc/ide/$DRIVE/media)
+ if [ x"$MEDIA" == x"cdrom" ]; then
+ KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE="$KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE
$DRIVE=cdrom"
+ COUNTER=$(($COUNTER+1))
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE="$KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE
$DRIVE=noprobe"
+ fi

211
5.3 Release Notes

+ done
+ # We don't find cdrom drive.
+ if [ $COUNTER -eq 0 ]; then
+ KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE=""
+ fi
}

# Load the kdump kerel specified in /etc/sysconfig/kdump


@@ -226,6 +269,8 @@

KDUMP_COMMANDLINE=`echo $KDUMP_COMMANDLINE | sed -e 's/crashkernel=[0-9]\+


[MmKkGg]@[0-9]\+[MmGgKk]//'`
KDUMP_COMMANDLINE="${KDUMP_COMMANDLINE} ${KDUMP_COMMANDLINE_APPEND}"
+ avoid_cdrom_drive
+ KDUMP_COMMANDLINE="${KDUMP_COMMANDLINE} ${KDUMP_IDE_NOPROBE_COMMANDLINE}"

KEXEC_OUTPUT=`$KEXEC $KEXEC_ARGS $standard_kexec_args \


--command-line="$KDUMP_COMMANDLINE" \
@@ -364,13 +409,7 @@

function do_final_action()
{
- FINAL_ACTION=`grep default $KDUMP_CONFIG_FILE | grep -vm1 ^\# \
- | cut -d\ -f2`
- if [[ $FINAL_ACTION != "halt" ]]; then
- FINAL_ACTION="reboot"
- fi
-
- $FINAL_ACTION
+ reboot
}

case "$1" in
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/network
---
+++
@@ -171,7 +171,7 @@
stop)
# Don't shut the network down if root is on NFS or a network
# block device.
- rootfs=$(awk '{ if ($1 !~ /^[ \t]*#/ && $2 == "/") { print $3; }}'
/etc/mtab)
+ rootfs=$(awk '{ if ($1 !~ /^[ \t]*#/ && $2 == "/" && $3 !=
"rootfs") { print $3; }}' /proc/mounts)
rootopts=$(awk '{ if ($1 !~ /^[ \t]*#/ && $2 == "/") { print $4;
}}' /etc/mtab)

if [[ "$rootfs" =~ "^nfs" ]] || [[ "$rootopts" =~ "_netdev|_rnetdev" ]] ;


then
nfs-utils-1.0.9-33.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/rpcidmapd
---
+++
@@ -24,7 +24,7 @@
case "$1" in
start|condstart)
# Check that networking is up.

212
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

- [ "${NETWORKING}" = "no" ] && exit 6


+ [ "${NETWORKING}" != "yes" ] && exit 6

[ ! -x /usr/sbin/rpc.idmapd ] && exit 5

@@ -32,6 +32,11 @@
[ "$1" = "condstart" -a -n "`pidofproc $prog`" ] && {
killproc $prog "-SIGHUP" > /dev/null
exit 0
+ }
+ [ "$1" = "start" ] && {
+ if status $prog > /dev/null ; then
+ exit 0
+ fi
}
rm -f $LOCKFILE

@@ -55,8 +60,6 @@
}
}
}
-
- # Make sure the mount worked.

# Start daemon.
daemon $prog ${RPCIDMAPDARGS}
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifup-sl
---
+++
@@ -31,7 +31,7 @@
[ -x /usr/sbin/dip ] || {
echo $"/usr/sbin/dip does not exist or is not executable"
echo $"ifup-sl for $DEVICE exiting"
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-sl \
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-sl \
$"/usr/sbin/dip does not exist or is not executable for $DEVICE"
exit 1
}
@@ -43,14 +43,14 @@
[ -f $DIPSCRIPT ] || {
echo $"/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/dip-$DEVICE does not exist"
echo $"ifup-sl for $DEVICE exiting"
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-sl \
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-sl \
$"/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/dip-$DEVICE does not exist for
$DEVICE"
exit 1
}

while : ; do
echo > /var/run/sl-$DEVICE.dev
- (logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-sl \
+ (/usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-sl \
$"dip started for $DEVICE on $MODEMPORT at $LINESPEED" &)&
doexec /usr/sbin/dip dip-$DEVICE $DIPSCRIPT
if [ "$PERSIST" != "yes" -o ! -f /var/run/sl-$DEVICE.dev ] ; then

213
5.3 Release Notes

ypserv-2.19-3.i386.rpm: /var/yp/Makefile
---
+++
@@ -98,10 +98,18 @@
YPSERVERS = $(YPDIR)/ypservers # List of all NIS servers for a domain

target: Makefile
+ifeq ($(shell /bin/domainname), (none))
+ @echo "Domain name cannot be (none)"
+else
+ifeq ($(shell /bin/domainname), )
+ @echo "Domain name must be set"
+else
@test ! -d $(LOCALDOMAIN) && mkdir $(LOCALDOMAIN) ; \
cd $(LOCALDOMAIN) ; \
$(NOPUSH) || $(MAKE) -f ../Makefile ypservers; \
$(MAKE) -f ../Makefile all
+endif
+endif

# If you don't want some of these maps built, feel free to comment
# them out from this list.
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/netfs
---
+++
@@ -35,6 +35,8 @@
# See how we were called.
case "$1" in
start)
+ # Let udev handle any backlog before trying to mount file systems
+ /sbin/udevsettle --timeout=30
[ -n "$NFSFSTAB" ] &&
{
[ ! -f /var/lock/subsys/portmap ] && service portmap start
nfs-utils-1.0.9-33.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/rpcsvcgssd
---
+++
@@ -27,12 +27,9 @@
case "$1" in
start|condstart)
# Check that networking is up.
- [ "${NETWORKING}" = "no" ] && exit 6
+ [ "${NETWORKING}" != "yes" ] && exit 6
[ "${SECURE_NFS}" != "yes" ] && exit 6
[ ! -x /usr/sbin/rpc.svcgssd ] && exit 5
-
- # List of kernel modules to load
- [ -z "${SECURE_NFS_MODS}" ] && SECURE_NFS_MODS="des rpcsec_gss_krb5"

# Make sure the daemon is not already running.


if status $prog > /dev/null ; then
@@ -41,6 +38,9 @@
rm -f $LOCKFILE

echo -n $"Starting RPC svcgssd: "


+ # List of kernel modules to load

214
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

+ [ -z "${SECURE_NFS_MODS}" ] && SECURE_NFS_MODS="des rpcsec_gss_krb5"


+

# Make sure the rpc_pipefs filesystem is available


[ "${RPCMTAB}" != "noload" ] && {
openldap-servers-2.3.27-8.el5_1.3.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/ldap
---
+++
@@ -21,7 +21,7 @@

# Source an auxiliary options file if we have one, and pick up OPTIONS,


# SLAPD_OPTIONS, SLURPD_OPTIONS, SLAPD_LDAPS, SLAPD_LDAPI, and maybe
-# KRB5_KTNAME.
+# KRB5_KTNAME and SLURPD_KRB5CCNAME.
if [ -r /etc/sysconfig/ldap ] ; then
. /etc/sysconfig/ldap
fi
@@ -114,7 +114,7 @@
echo -n $"$file is not readable by \"$user\"" ; warning ; echo
fi
# Unaccessible TLS configuration files.
- tlsconfigs=`LANG=C egrep
'^(TLSCACertificateFile|TLSCertificateFile|TLSCertificateKeyFile)
[[:space:]]' /etc/openldap/slapd.conf | awk '{print $2}'`
+ tlsconfigs=`LANG=C egrep
'^(TLS_CACERT|TLSCACertificateFile|TLSCertificateFile|TLSCertificateKeyFile)
[[:space:]]' /etc/openldap/slapd.conf /etc/openldap/ldap.conf | awk '{print
$2}'`
for file in $tlsconfigs ; do
if ! testasuser $user -r $file ; then
echo -n $"$file is not readable by \"$user\"" ; warning ; echo
@@ -167,6 +167,9 @@
if grep -q "^replogfile" /etc/openldap/slapd.conf; then
prog=`basename ${slurpd}`
echo -n $"Starting $prog: "
+ if [ -n "$SLURPD_KRB5CCNAME" ]; then
+ export KRB5CCNAME="$SLURPD_KRB5CCNAME";
+ fi
daemon ${slurpd} $OPTIONS $SLURPD_OPTIONS
RETVAL=$?
echo
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/rc.sysinit
---
+++
@@ -143,7 +143,7 @@
skip=""
# Parse the src field for UUID= and convert to real device names
if [ "${src%%=*}" == "UUID" ]; then
- src=`/sbin/blkid -t "$src" -o device|(read oneline;echo $oneline)`
+ src=$(/sbin/blkid -t "$src" -l -o device)
elif [ "${src/^\/dev\/disk\/by-uuid\/}" != "$src" ]; then
src=$(__readlink $src)
fi
@@ -458,6 +458,13 @@
fi
fi

215
5.3 Release Notes

+if [ -f /etc/crypttab ]; then


+ s=$"Starting disk encryption:"
+ echo "$s"
+ init_crypto 0 && success "$s" || failure "$s"
+ echo
+fi
+
if [ -f /fastboot ] || strstr "$cmdline" fastboot ; then
fastboot=yes
fi
@@ -533,7 +540,7 @@
mountopts=

# Scan partitions for local scratch storage


- rw_mount_dev=$(blkid -t LABEL="$RW_LABEL" -o device | awk '{ print ; exit
}')
+ rw_mount_dev=$(blkid -t LABEL="$RW_LABEL" -l -o device)

# First try to mount scratch storage from /etc/fstab, then any


# partition with the proper label. If either succeeds, be sure
@@ -590,12 +597,12 @@

# First try to mount persistent data from /etc/fstab, then any


# partition with the proper label, then fallback to NFS
- state_mount_dev=$(blkid -t LABEL="$STATE_LABEL" -o device | awk '{ print ;
exit }')
- if mount $mountopts "$STATE_MOUNT" > /dev/null 2>&1 ; then
+ state_mount_dev=$(blkid -t LABEL="$STATE_LABEL" -l -o device)
+ if mount $mountopts $STATE_OPTIONS "$STATE_MOUNT" > /dev/null 2>&1 ; then
/bin/true
elif [ x$state_mount_dev != x ] && mount $state_mount_dev $mountopts
"$STATE_MOUNT" > /dev/null 2>&1; then
/bin/true
- elif [ -n "$CLIENTSTATE" ]; then
+ elif [ ! -z "$CLIENTSTATE" ]; then
# No local storage was found. Make a final attempt to find
# state on an NFS server.

@@ -730,23 +737,29 @@
restorecon /etc/mtab /etc/ld.so.cache /etc/blkid/blkid.tab
/etc/resolv.conf >/dev/null 2>&1
fi

-# Clear mtab
-(> /etc/mtab) &> /dev/null
-
-# Remove stale backups
-rm -f /etc/mtab~ /etc/mtab~~
-
-# Enter mounted filesystems into /etc/mtab
-mount -f /
-mount -f /proc >/dev/null 2>&1
-mount -f /sys >/dev/null 2>&1
-mount -f /dev/pts >/dev/null 2>&1
-mount -f /proc/bus/usb >/dev/null 2>&1

216
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

+if [ "$READONLY" != "yes" ] ; then


+ # Clear mtab
+ (> /etc/mtab) &> /dev/null
+
+ # Remove stale backups
+ rm -f /etc/mtab~ /etc/mtab~~
+
+ # Enter mounted filesystems into /etc/mtab
+ mount -f /
+ mount -f /proc >/dev/null 2>&1
+ mount -f /sys >/dev/null 2>&1
+ mount -f /dev/pts >/dev/null 2>&1
+ mount -f /proc/bus/usb >/dev/null 2>&1
+fi

# Mount all other filesystems (except for NFS and /proc, which is already
# mounted). Contrary to standard usage,
# filesystems are NOT unmounted in single user mode.
-action $"Mounting local filesystems: " mount -a -t
nonfs,nfs4,smbfs,ncpfs,cifs,gfs -O no_netdev
+if [ "$READONLY" != "yes" ] ; then
+ action $"Mounting local filesystems: " mount -a -t
nonfs,nfs4,smbfs,ncpfs,cifs,gfs -O no_netdev
+else
+ action $"Mounting local filesystems: " mount -a -n -t
nfs4,smbfs,ncpfs,cifs,gfs -O no_netdev
+fi

if [ -x /sbin/quotaon ]; then
action $"Enabling local filesystem quotas: " /sbin/quotaon -aug
@@ -898,7 +911,7 @@
action $"Enabling /etc/fstab swaps: " swapon -a -e
if [ "$AUTOSWAP" = "yes" ]; then
curswap=$(awk '/^\/dev/ { print $1 }' /proc/swaps | while read x; do
get_numeric_dev dec $x ; echo -n " "; done)
- swappartitions=`blkid -t TYPE=swap -o device`
+ swappartitions=$(blkid -t TYPE=swap -o device)
if [ x"$swappartitions" != x ]; then
for partition in $swappartitions ; do
[ ! -e $partition ] && continue
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifdown-sl
---
+++
@@ -35,7 +35,7 @@

kill -KILL $PID > /dev/null 2>&1


if [ -d /proc/$PID ]; then
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifdown-ppp "ifdown-ppp unable to kill pppd-
$DEVICE" &
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifdown-ppp "ifdown-ppp unable to kill
pppd-$DEVICE" &
else
/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifdown-post $1
fi
NetworkManager-0.6.4-8.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/NetworkManager
---

217
5.3 Release Notes

+++
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
#
# chkconfig: - 98 02
# description: This is a daemon for automatically switching network \
-# connections to the best available connection. \
+# connections to the best available connection.
#
# processname: NetworkManager
# pidfile: /var/run/NetworkManager/NetworkManager.pid
@@ -19,11 +19,11 @@
# Sanity checks.
[ -x $NETWORKMANAGER_BIN ] || exit 1

-# We need /sbin/ip
-[ -x /sbin/ip ] || exit 1
-
# Source function library.
. /etc/rc.d/init.d/functions
+
+# Source network configuration
+. /etc/sysconfig/network

# so we can rearrange this easily


processname=NetworkManager
@@ -34,17 +34,23 @@

start()
{
- echo $"Setting network parameters... "
+ echo -n $"Setting network parameters... "
sysctl -e -p /etc/sysctl.conf >/dev/null 2>&1
-
- if [ ! -e /var/lock/subsys/dhcdbd ]; then
- service dhcdbd start
- fi
+ success
+ echo

echo -n $"Starting NetworkManager daemon: "


- daemon --check $servicename $processname --pid-file=$pidfile
+ daemon --check $servicename $processname --pid-file=$pidfile --ppp-dns-
workaround
RETVAL=$?
echo
+ if [ -n "${NETWORKWAIT}" ]; then
+ [ -z "${LINKDELAY}" ] && LINKDELAY=10
+ echo -n $"Waiting for network..."
+ nm-online -q --timeout=$LINKDELAY || nm-online -q -x --timeout=30
+ [ "$?" = "0" ] && success "network startup" || failure "network startup"
+ echo
+ [ -n "${NETWORKDELAY}" ] && /bin/sleep ${NETWORKDELAY}
+ fi
[ $RETVAL -eq 0 ] && touch /var/lock/subsys/$servicename
}

218
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/network-
functions-ipv6
---
+++
@@ -138,14 +138,14 @@
;;
'syslog')
# note: logger resides in /usr/bin, but not used by default
- if ! [ -x logger ]; then
+ if ! [ -x /usr/bin/logger ]; then
echo $"ERROR: [ipv6_log] Syslog is chosen, but binary 'logger' doesn't
exist or isn't executable" >/dev/stderr
return 3
fi
if [ -z "$txt_name" ]; then
- logger -p $facility.$priority $message
+ /usr/bin/logger -p $facility.$priority $message
else
- logger -p $facility.$priority -t "$txt_name" "$message"
+ /usr/bin/logger -p $facility.$priority -t "$txt_name" "$message"
fi
;;
*)
nfs-utils-1.0.9-33.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/nfs
---
+++
@@ -19,6 +19,9 @@
# Check for and source configuration file otherwise set defaults
[ -f /etc/sysconfig/nfs ] && . /etc/sysconfig/nfs

+# Remote quota server


+[ -z "$RQUOTAD" ] && RQUOTAD=`type -path rpc.rquotad`
+
RETVAL=0

# See how we were called.


@@ -26,11 +29,16 @@
start)

# Check that networking is up.


- [ "${NETWORKING}" = "no" ] && exit 6
+ [ "${NETWORKING}" != "yes" ] && exit 6

[ -x /usr/sbin/rpc.nfsd ] || exit 5
[ -x /usr/sbin/rpc.mountd ] || exit 5
[ -x /usr/sbin/exportfs ] || exit 5
+
+ # Make sure the rpc.mountd is not already running.
+ if status rpc.mountd > /dev/null ; then
+ exit 0
+ fi

# Don't fail if /etc/exports doesn't exist; create a bare-bones


# version and continue.
@@ -42,9 +50,6 @@

219
5.3 Release Notes

# Number of servers to be started by default


[ -z "$RPCNFSDCOUNT" ] && RPCNFSDCOUNT=8
-
- # Remote quota server
- [ -z "$RQUOTAD" ] && RQUOTAD=`type -path rpc.rquotad`

# Start daemons.
[ -x /usr/sbin/rpc.svcgssd ] && /sbin/service rpcsvcgssd start
@@ -67,6 +72,12 @@
RETVAL=$?
echo
fi
+
+ # Load preload module so arguments to rpc.nfsd will take effect
+ [ -n "$RPCNFSDARGS" -a "$NFSD_MODULE" != "noload" ] && {
+ [ -x /sbin/modprobe ] && /sbin/modprobe nfsd
+ }
+
echo -n $"Starting NFS daemon: "
daemon rpc.nfsd $RPCNFSDARGS $RPCNFSDCOUNT
RETVAL=$?
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/network-
functions
---
+++
@@ -28,7 +28,7 @@

get_config_by_subchannel ()
{
- LANG=C grep -il "^[[:space:]]*SUBCHANNELS=${1}\([[:space:]#]\|$\|,\)"
/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifcfg-* \
+ LANG=C egrep -i -l "^[[:space:]]*SUBCHANNELS=([0-9]\.[0-9]\.[a-f0-
9]+,){0,2}${1}(,[0-9]\.[0-9]\.[a-f0-9]+){0,2}([[:space:]]+#|[[:space:]]*$)"
/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifcfg-* \
| LC_ALL=C sed -e "$__sed_discard_ignored_files"
}

@@ -434,7 +434,7 @@
(echo "$s" > /etc/resolv.conf;) >/dev/null 2>&1;
r=$?
if [ $r -eq 0 ]; then
- logger -p local7.notice -t "NET" -i "$0 : updated /etc/resolv.conf";
+ /usr/bin/logger -p local7.notice -t "NET" -i "$0 : updated
/etc/resolv.conf";
[ -e /var/lock/subsys/nscd ] && /usr/sbin/nscd -i hosts; # invalidate
cache
fi;
return $r;
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/rc0.d/S01halt
---
+++
@@ -10,6 +10,9 @@

NOLOCALE=1
. /etc/init.d/functions
+

220
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

+UMOUNT="umount"
+[ ! -w /etc ] && UMOUNT="umount -n"

action() {
echo -n "$1 "
@@ -131,7 +134,7 @@
# Try to unmount tmpfs filesystems to avoid swapping them in. Ignore
failures.
tmpfs=$(awk '$2 ~ /^\/($|proc|dev)/ { next; }
$3 == "tmpfs" { print $2; }' /proc/mounts | sort -r)
-[ -n "$tmpfs" ] && fstab-decode umount $tmpfs 2>/dev/null
+[ -n "$tmpfs" ] && fstab-decode $UMOUNT $tmpfs 2>/dev/null

# Turn off swap, then unmount file systems.


[ -f /proc/swaps ] && SWAPS=`awk '! /^Filename/ { print $1 }' /proc/swaps`
@@ -143,8 +146,6 @@
backdev=$(/sbin/cryptsetup status "$dst" \
| awk '$1 == "device:" { print $2 }')
/sbin/cryptsetup remove "$dst"
- # Leave partition with a blank plain-text swap
- mkswap "$backdev" > /dev/null
fi
done
fi
@@ -170,7 +171,7 @@
$"Unmounting file systems (retry): " \
-f

-[ -f /proc/bus/usb/devices ] && umount /proc/bus/usb


+[ -f /proc/bus/usb/devices ] && $UMOUNT /proc/bus/usb

[ -f /etc/crypttab ] && \
LANG=C action $"Stopping disk encryption: " halt_crypto
@@ -183,7 +184,7 @@
awk '$2 !~ /\/(|dev|proc|selinux)$/ && $1 !~ /^\/dev\/ram/ { print $2 }' \
/proc/mounts | sort -r | \
while read line; do
- fstab-decode umount -f $line
+ fstab-decode $UMOUNT -f $line
done

if [ -x /sbin/halt.local ]; then
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/halt
---
+++
@@ -10,6 +10,9 @@

NOLOCALE=1
. /etc/init.d/functions
+
+UMOUNT="umount"
+[ ! -w /etc ] && UMOUNT="umount -n"

action() {
echo -n "$1 "
@@ -131,7 +134,7 @@

221
5.3 Release Notes

# Try to unmount tmpfs filesystems to avoid swapping them in. Ignore


failures.
tmpfs=$(awk '$2 ~ /^\/($|proc|dev)/ { next; }
$3 == "tmpfs" { print $2; }' /proc/mounts | sort -r)
-[ -n "$tmpfs" ] && fstab-decode umount $tmpfs 2>/dev/null
+[ -n "$tmpfs" ] && fstab-decode $UMOUNT $tmpfs 2>/dev/null

# Turn off swap, then unmount file systems.


[ -f /proc/swaps ] && SWAPS=`awk '! /^Filename/ { print $1 }' /proc/swaps`
@@ -143,8 +146,6 @@
backdev=$(/sbin/cryptsetup status "$dst" \
| awk '$1 == "device:" { print $2 }')
/sbin/cryptsetup remove "$dst"
- # Leave partition with a blank plain-text swap
- mkswap "$backdev" > /dev/null
fi
done
fi
@@ -170,7 +171,7 @@
$"Unmounting file systems (retry): " \
-f

-[ -f /proc/bus/usb/devices ] && umount /proc/bus/usb


+[ -f /proc/bus/usb/devices ] && $UMOUNT /proc/bus/usb

[ -f /etc/crypttab ] && \
LANG=C action $"Stopping disk encryption: " halt_crypto
@@ -183,7 +184,7 @@
awk '$2 !~ /\/(|dev|proc|selinux)$/ && $1 !~ /^\/dev\/ram/ { print $2 }' \
/proc/mounts | sort -r | \
while read line; do
- fstab-decode umount -f $line
+ fstab-decode $UMOUNT -f $line
done

if [ -x /sbin/halt.local ]; then
nfs-utils-1.0.9-33.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/nfslock
---
+++
@@ -33,7 +33,7 @@
RETVAL=0
start() {
# Check that networking is up.
- [ "${NETWORKING}" = "no" ] && exit 6
+ [ "${NETWORKING}" != "yes" ] && exit 6

if [ "$USERLAND_LOCKD" ] ; then
[ -x /sbin/rpc.lockd ] || exit 5
@@ -46,9 +46,12 @@
STATDARG=""
fi

- if [ -f /var/lock/subsys/nfslock ]; then
- return $RETVAL
+ # Make sure the rpc.statd is not already running.
+ if status rpc.statd > /dev/null ; then

222
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

+ exit 0
fi
+ rm -f /var/lock/subsys/nfslock
+
# Start daemons.
if [ "$USERLAND_LOCKD" ]; then
echo -n $"Starting NFS locking: "
@@ -64,10 +67,14 @@
/sbin/sysctl -w fs.nfs.nlm_udpport=$LOCKD_UDPPORT >/dev/null 2>&1
fi
echo -n $"Starting NFS statd: "
+ # Set statd's local hostname if defined
+ [ -n "${STATD_HOSTNAME}" ] && STATDARG="$STATDARG -n ${STATD_HOSTNAME}"
+
# See if a statd's ports has been defined
[ -n "$STATD_PORT" ] && STATDARG="$STATDARG -p $STATD_PORT"
[ -n "$STATD_OUTGOING_PORT" ] \
&& STATDARG="$STATDARG -o $STATD_OUTGOING_PORT"
+
# See if we have an HA-callout program specified
[ -n "$STATD_HA_CALLOUT" ] \
&& STATDARG="$STATDARG -H $STATD_HA_CALLOUT"
@@ -91,6 +98,7 @@
RETVAL=$?
echo
rm -f /var/lock/subsys/nfslock
+ rm -f /var/run/sm-notify.pid
return $RETVAL
}

dbus-1.0.0-7.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/dbus-1/system.conf
---
+++
@@ -15,10 +15,16 @@
<type>system</type>

<!-- Run as special user -->


- <user>81</user>
+ <user>dbus</user>

<!-- Fork into daemon mode -->


<fork/>
+
+ <!-- We use system service launching using a helper -->
+ <standard_system_servicedirs/>
+
+ <!-- This is a setuid helper that is used to launch system services -->
+ <servicehelper>/lib/dbus-1/dbus-daemon-launch-helper</servicehelper>

<!-- Write a pid file -->


<pidfile>/var/run/messagebus.pid</pidfile>
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifup-eth
---
+++
@@ -105,9 +105,10 @@

223
5.3 Release Notes

# slave device?
if [ "${SLAVE}" = yes -a "${ISALIAS}" = no -a "${MASTER}" != "" ]; then
- /sbin/ip link set dev ${DEVICE} down
- echo "+${DEVICE}" > /sys/class/net/${MASTER}/bonding/slaves 2>/dev/null
-
+ grep -wq "${DEVICE}" /sys/class/net/${MASTER}/bonding/slaves || {
+ /sbin/ip link set dev ${DEVICE} down
+ echo "+${DEVICE}" > /sys/class/net/${MASTER}/bonding/slaves 2>/dev/null
+ }
if [ -n "$ETHTOOL_OPTS" ] ; then
/sbin/ethtool -s ${REALDEVICE} $ETHTOOL_OPTS
fi
@@ -125,7 +126,7 @@
for arg in $BONDING_OPTS ; do
key=${arg%%=*};
value=${arg##*=};
- if [ "${key}" = "arp_ip_target" ]; then
+ if [ "${key}" = "arp_ip_target" -a "${value:0:1}" != "+" ]; then
OLDIFS=$IFS;
IFS=',';
for arp_ip in $value; do
initscripts-8.45.19.EL-1.i386.rpm: /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/ifup-ppp
---
+++
@@ -44,7 +44,7 @@
[ -x /sbin/pppd -o -x /usr/sbin/pppd ] || {
echo $"pppd does not exist or is not executable"
echo $"ifup-ppp for ${DEVICE} exiting"
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
$"pppd does not exist or is not executable for ${DEVICE}"
exit 1
}
@@ -55,7 +55,7 @@
adsl-start /etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/$CONFIG
exit $?
else
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
$"adsl-start does not exist or is not executable for ${DEVICE}"
exit 1
fi
@@ -76,12 +76,12 @@
[ -f ${CHATSCRIPT} ] || {
echo $"/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/chat-${DEVNAME} does not exist"
echo $"ifup-ppp for ${DEVNAME} exiting"
- logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
+ /usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
$"/etc/sysconfig/network-scripts/chat-${DEVNAME} does not exist for
${DEVICE}"
exit 1
}
fi
- logger -s -p daemon.notice -t ifup-ppp \
+ /usr/bin/logger -s -p daemon.notice -t ifup-ppp \
$"Setting up a new ${PEERCONF} config file"

224
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

if [ -f /etc/ppp/peers/${DEVICE} ]; then
cp -f /etc/ppp/peers/${DEVICE} ${PEERCONF}
@@ -141,7 +141,7 @@
exec=exec
fi

-(logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \


+(/usr/bin/logger -p daemon.info -t ifup-ppp \
$"pppd started for ${DEVNAME} on ${MODEMPORT} at ${LINESPEED}" &)&

$exec pppd $opts ${MODEMPORT} ${LINESPEED} \


tog-pegasus-2.7.0-2.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/rc.d/init.d/tog-pegasus
---
+++
@@ -8,6 +8,8 @@
CIMSERVER_BIN=/usr/sbin/cimserver
prog=cimserver
LOCKFILE=/var/lock/subsys/tog-pegasus
+LOCKFILE2=/var/run/tog-pegasus/cimserver_start.lock
+PIDFILE=/var/run/tog-pegasus/cimserver.pid
. /etc/rc.d/init.d/functions

[ -e /etc/sysconfig/tog-pegasus ] && . /etc/sysconfig/tog-pegasus;


@@ -75,6 +77,7 @@
success;
else
failure;
+ RETVAL=7
fi
echo
;;
@@ -86,8 +89,16 @@
echo -n $"CIM server ($pid) is running";
RETVAL=0
else
- echo -n $"CIM server is not running";
- RETVAL=3
+ if [ -e $PIDFILE ]; then
+ echo -n $"CIM server is not running and pid file exists";
+ RETVAL=1
+ elif [ -e $LOCKFILE ] || [ -e $LOCKFILE2 ]; then
+ echo -n $"CIM server is not running and lock file exists";
+ RETVAL=2
+ else
+ echo -n $"CIM server is not running";
+ RETVAL=3
+ fi
fi
echo
;;
udev-095-14.16.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/udev/rules.d/50-udev.rules
---
+++
@@ -174,7 +174,7 @@
KERNEL=="mice", NAME="input/%k"
KERNEL=="mouse*", NAME="input/%k"

225
5.3 Release Notes

-KERNEL=="event*", SYSFS{idVendor}=="03f0",
SYSFS{device/interface}=="Virtual Mouse",
SYSFS{device/bInterfaceProtocol}=="02", NAME="input/%k",
SYMLINK+="input/hp_ilo_mouse"
+KERNEL=="event*", SYSFS{idVendor}=="03f0",
SYSFS{device/interface}=="Virtual Mouse",
SYSFS{device/bInterfaceProtocol}=="02", SYMLINK+="input/hp_ilo_mouse"

KERNEL=="event*", NAME="input/%k"
KERNEL=="js*", NAME="input/%k", SYMLINK+="%k"
@@ -220,13 +220,6 @@
KERNEL=="pcd[0-9]*", SYMLINK+="cdrom cdrom-%k"
KERNEL=="fd[0-9]*", SYMLINK+="floppy floppy-%k"

-# Section for zaptel device


-KERNEL=="zapctl", NAME="zap/ctl"
-KERNEL=="zaptimer", NAME="zap/timer"
-KERNEL=="zapchannel", NAME="zap/channel"
-KERNEL=="zappseudo", NAME="zap/pseudo"
-KERNEL=="zap[0-9]*", NAME="zap/%n"
-
KERNEL=="pktcdvd", NAME="%k/control"

KERNEL=="hd[a-z]", BUS=="ide", SYSFS{removable}=="1", \


@@ -291,12 +284,14 @@
KERNEL=="sd*[!0-9]|sr*", ENV{ID_SERIAL}=="",
IMPORT{program}="/lib/udev/scsi_id -g -x -a -s %p -d $tempnode"
KERNEL=="dasd*[!0-9]", IMPORT{program}="/lib/udev/dasd_id --export
$tempnode"
KERNEL=="nst[0-9]*|st*|sd*[!0-9]|sr*|dasd*[!0-9]|cciss?c",
ENV{ID_SERIAL}=="?*", SYMLINK+="disk/by-id/$env{ID_BUS}-$env{ID_SERIAL}"
+KERNEL=="nst[0-9]*|st*|sd*[!0-9]|sr*|dasd*[!0-9]|cciss?c", ENV{ID_UID}=="?
*", SYMLINK+="disk/by-id/$env{ID_BUS}-$env{ID_UID}"

# for partitions import parent information


KERNEL=="sd*[0-9]|dasd*[0-9]", IMPORT{parent}=="ID_*"
KERNEL=="cciss?c[0-9]d[0-9]", ENV{ID_SERIAL}!="?*",
IMPORT{program}="scsi_id -g -x -s %p -d $tempnode", ENV{ID_BUS}="cciss"
KERNEL=="cciss?c[0-9]d[0-9]", ENV{ID_SERIAL}!="?*",
IMPORT{program}="scsi_id -g -x -a -s %p -d $tempnode", ENV{ID_BUS}="cciss"
KERNEL=="sd*[0-9]|dasd*[0-9]|cciss*p[0-9]", ENV{ID_SERIAL}=="?*",
SYMLINK+="disk/by-id/$env{ID_BUS}-$env{ID_SERIAL}-part%n"
+KERNEL=="sd*[0-9]|dasd*[0-9]|cciss*p[0-9]", ENV{ID_UID}=="?*",
SYMLINK+="disk/by-id/$env{ID_BUS}-$env{ID_UID}-part%n"

# by-path (shortest physical path)


KERNEL=="*[!0-9]|sr*", ENV{ID_TYPE}=="?*",
IMPORT{program}="/lib/udev/path_id %p", SYMLINK+="disk/by-path/$env{ID_PATH}"
dbus-1.0.0-7.el5.i386.rpm: /etc/dbus-1/session.conf
---
+++
@@ -14,12 +14,16 @@

<policy context="default">
<!-- Allow everything to be sent -->

226
13. Configuration Changes From Previous Release

- <allow send_destination="*"/>
+ <allow send_destination="*" eavesdrop="true"/>
<!-- Allow everything to be received -->
<allow eavesdrop="true"/>
<!-- Allow anyone to own anything -->
<allow own="*"/>
</policy>
+
+ <!-- Config files are placed here that among other things,
+ further restrict the above policy for specific services. -->
+ <includedir>session.d</includedir>

<!-- This is included last so local configuration can override what's


in this standard file -->
@@ -27,4 +31,27 @@

<include if_selinux_enabled="yes"
selinux_root_relative="yes">contexts/dbus_contexts</include>

+ <!-- For the session bus, override the default relatively-low limits
+ with essentially infinite limits, since the bus is just running
+ as the user anyway, using up bus resources is not something we need
+ to worry about. In some cases, we do set the limits lower than
+ "all available memory" if exceeding the limit is almost certainly a
bug,
+ having the bus enforce a limit is nicer than a huge memory leak. But
the
+ intent is that these limits should never be hit. -->
+
+ <!-- the memory limits are 1G instead of say 4G because they can't exceed
32-bit signed int max -->
+ <limit name="max_incoming_bytes">1000000000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_outgoing_bytes">1000000000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_message_size">1000000000</limit>
+ <limit name="service_start_timeout">120000</limit>
+ <limit name="auth_timeout">240000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_completed_connections">100000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_incomplete_connections">10000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_connections_per_user">100000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_pending_service_starts">10000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_names_per_connection">50000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_match_rules_per_connection">50000</limit>
+ <limit name="max_replies_per_connection">50000</limit>
+ <limit name="reply_timeout">300000</limit>
+
</busconfig>

227
5.3 Release Notes

A. Revision History

Revision 2.1-0.400 2013-10-31 Rüdiger Landmann


Rebuild with publican 4.0.0

Revision 2.1-0 Wed Jan 21 2009 Ryan Lerch


Removed iSCSI target capability note from Technology Previews section. This feature is fully supported. For
more details on this newly supported feature, refer to the Feature Updates Section of this document.

228

You might also like